victorian mount a i 010590 mbp
DESCRIPTION
Victorian MOUNTAINEERSTRANSCRIPT
?96. 53-5301.5
796.5 C59v 53-53015ClarkVictorian Mountaineers.
nly n P~~ntat.cn oi proper
on tiScard^^ resP nsible for all books drawn
f r Ver'due ^^ 2c a d^ Plus cost of
f must be ra-
Public LibraryKansas City, Mo.
TENSION ENVELOPE COHP.
KANSAS CITY, MO PUBLIC LIBRARY
D ODD1 H57D15b 1
THEVICTORIAN MOUNTAINEERS
Frontispiece
i British Mountaineers in the early i.S6o's
Al
?ta,&3 \Ofcz4sft;
London
B. T. BATSFORD LTD
ToP. D. W.-B.
First published, 1953
PRINTED AND BOUND IN CREAT BRITAIN BY JARROI.D AND SONS ITDLONDON AND NORWICH, FOR TUB PUBLISHERS
B. T. BATSFORD X.TD4 HTZHARDINGB STREET, PORTMAN SQUARB, LONDON W.I
CONTENTSPage
ACKNOWLEDGMENT 9
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS 10
NOTES ON THE ILLUSTRATIONS 12
INTRODUCTION: Half of their Lives 15
Chapter
One The Prophets 29
Two Pioneers, O Pioneers 57
Three The Alpine Club 78
Four The Scientists 91
Five The Clergy no
Six Whymper, the Man with the Chipon his Shoulder 122
Seven Coolidge, the Boswell of the Alps 145
Eight The Women 174
Nine The Mountaineers in Britain 186
Ten Conway, the Victorian Mountaineer 206
INDEX 225
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
THEauthor wishes to thank: T. S. Blakeney, James Reid,
Mrs. George Starkey, Doctor Monroe Thorington and Mrs.
Winthrop Young, among many others, for help and advice;
Doctor Sieber of the Zentralbibliothek, Zurich, for his kind
co-operation with the Coolidge material; the Editor of The
CornhillMagazine for kind permission to use the material incor-
porated in an article in that journal; all those people who have
lent illustrations, and made available information, which it has
been impossible to incorporate in this book; and the late Ashley P.
Abraham, for figs. 36-44; the Alpine Club, forfigs.
10 and 20;
Mrs. Vanessa Bell, for figs. 15 and 16; Captain Neville B. C.
Brock, for figs. 24-28; the Centre Alpin de Zermatt, for fig. 5; Mr.
Peter Eaton, for fig. 19; Mr. Helmut Gernsheim, for fig. 4; Major-General R. S. Lewis, C.B., O.B.E., for fig. 29; Mr. Hugh Merrick
for fig. 34; Mrs. Mary Howard McClintock, for fig. 31; Lieu-
tenant-General E. F. Norton, C.B., D.S.O., M.C., for figs. 3 and
8; Picture Post Library, for figs, i, 2, 6, 7, 17 and 18; Miss Dorothy
Pilkington, for figs. 13, 22 and 33; the Royal Geographical
Society, for figs.21 and 45; the Royal Institution, for fig. n;
Mr. C. W. Rubenson, of Oslo, for fig. 35; the Swiss Alpine Club,
for fig. 23 ;Mr. Charles Vaughan, for fig. 30. Fig. 15 is reproduced
from a photograph supplied by Messrs. McGibbon and Kee from
Leslie Stephen by Noel Annan. Thanks are also due to the follow-
ing publishers for granting their permission to make quotations:
Messrs, Jonathan Cape Ltd., The Autobiography of a Mountain
Climber by Lord Conway of Allington; Messrs. Longmans Green
and Co. Ltd., Time and Chance by Doctor Joan Evans, and
Wanderings by Alfred Wills; Messrs. John Murray Ltd., Scrambles
amongst the Alps by Edward Whymper; and dieJournal ofthe Fell
and Rock Climbing Club of the English Lake District for the account
of Haskett-Smith's first ascent of the Napes Needle.
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure
1 British Mountaineers in the early i86o's Frontispiece
2 John Ruskin 13
3 Members of the Wills Family on the Col d'Anterne 14
4 Albert Smith 14
5 Charles Hudson 33
6 John Ball, First President of the Alpine Club 33
7 JohnTyndall 33
8 Sir Alfred Wills and a Family Group at the Eagle's
Nest 34
9 A Group on the Mer de Glace above Chamonix 59
10 A Group ofBritish Climbers at Zermatt in the late 1 86o's 60
11 John Tyndall outside the Bel Alp with his Wife, 1876 85
12 The Rev. Hereford George's Party on the Lower
Grindelwald Glacier, 1865 85
13 Lawrence and Charles Pilkington and Frederick
Gardiner 86
14 Ulrich Aimer saving his Employers on the Obcr
Gabelhorn 103
15 Leslie Stephen: with his Guide, Melchior Anderegg 104
16 Leslie Stephen: on one ofhis later visits to Grindelwald 104
17, 18 On the Mer de Glace in the late 1870'$ 117
19 Sir Edward Davidson and his Guides II 8
20 Edward Whymper: as a Man of 25 135
21 Edward Whymper: in his Middle Fifties 135
22 Grindelwald Guides of the Mid-Victorian Age 136
23 A letter fromW. A. B. Coolidge to his Mother follow-
ing his first visit to Zermatt 149
10
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Page
24 Miss Brevoort 150
25 W. A. B. Coolidge 150
26, 27 Tschingel, and the Printed List of her Peaks and
Passes 150
28 W. A. B. Coolidge and Albert, his manservant, at
Grindelwald 159
29 A Group taken in the late i86o's showing Miss Straton
and Miss Emmeline Lewis-Lloyd 160
30 A Group taken in the i86o's showing Miss Straton and
Jean Charlet 169
31 Prince Arthur, Duke of Connaught, at the Grands
Mulcts, Mont Blanc, in 1864, at the age of 14 170
32 Queen Victoria ascending Lochnagar, near Balmoral 179
3 3 Mrs. Jackson 1 80
34 Miss Maud Meyer 180
35 Cecil SHngsby, in 1876, at the age of 27 189
36 "The Keswick Brothers": Ashley P. and George D.
Abraham 190
37 The Rev. James "Steeple" Jackson 190
38 O. G.Jones climbing in Derbyshire 199
39 J. W. Robinson and George Seatree at a Camp, near
Sty Head 199
40 The "Stable-Door Traverse" at Wastdale Head 200
41 W. P. Haskett-Smith in his early climbing days 200
42 The Spring Meet of the Cairngorm Club on Mount
Keen, 1890 209
43 A Group of Climbers outside Pen-y-Gwryd, North
Wales, 1898 210
44 A Group on Cader Idris in 1897 219
45 Lord Conway of Allington 220
NOTES ON THEILLUSTRATIONS
FEWphotographs of the earlier Victorian mountaineers were ever taken;
fewer still have survived the salvage drives of two world wars and the
bombings ofone. Even when photographs are discovered there is, too often, no
means ofidentifying, beyond all possible doubt, those climbers who are shown.
Even the dates can often be surmised only from the clothes or, more
frequently, from the type of alpenstock or ice-axe carried.
In spite of this the following notes on some of the pictures, however incom-
plete, may be of interest.
The frontispiece, fig. i, is one of the earliest photographs showing a
woman mountaineer. The couple are believed to be Lucy Walker and her
brother, Horace Walker, although it has been suggested that her companion
might be A. W. Moore.
In fig. 3, J. T. Wills, son of Sir Alfred Wills, is shown seated on the far
left. Second and fourth from left are Mrs. Edward Norton (daughter of
Sir Alfred) and Edward Norton, mother and father of General E. F. Norton.
In fig. 14, from a drawing by H. G. Willink, is shown die incident when,as described by an eyewitness, "... a huge mass of cornice fell, carryingwith it the leading guide, Brantschen, and the two voyageurs. Aimer, whoalone remained on terra firma . . . leaped a yard backwards, plunged his axe
into the snow, and planting himself as firmly as possible, was thus enabled to
arrest the fall of the entire party down a precipice ofsome 2,000 feet/*
Fig. 19 is from a photograph taken by W. F. Donkin at die Montanvcrtin 1882. Davidson's guides are Andreas Jaun (left)
and Hans Jaun.In fig. 22, Christian Aimer, most famous of all the Oberland guides, is
seen shielding the bottom right-hand end of the ladder, withrope over right
shoulder and ice-axe in left hand. Below him, and to his left, with ropeover left shoulder, is his son, "young Christian".
Infig. 31, Prince Arthur is seen centre, holding alpenstock. On his left,
holding alpenstock, is Major Elphinstone, V.C.; on his right is Colonel
Seymour.In
fig. 42 is seen the spring excursion of the Cairngorm Club to die top ofMount Keen on May 5th. Described as the highlight of die 1890 season, the
meet attracted a record total of 162 people, including a boy of six, a man of
seventy-six and 45 ladies. A formal meeting of the Club was held on the
summit.
Infig. 43, Dr. Collier sits at the far left of the centre row with, next to
him, Oscar Eckcnstein.
Infig. 44 there is shown, from left to right, Ashley P. Abraham, C. Fox,
W.J. Williams, O. G. Jones and George D. Abraham.
12
z John Raskin
I
3 Members of the Wills Family on the
Col d'Antcrne above the Eagle's Nest
4 Albert Smith
INTRODUCTIONHALF OF THEIR LIVES
I go, Fate drives me, lut I leave
Halfofmy lifewith you.
ARNOLD
' I *HERE is something a little surprising and slightly indecorous
J_ about the fact that the Victorians, the bearded gentlemenfrom the family albums, provided the first considerable body of
mountaineers that the world had ever known.
They were, at first glance, essentially indoor gentlemen. Their
portraits were taken against the backcloth rather than the land-
scape; their clothes were such as to make movement difficult and
violent action, one might well imagine from the illustrations
which have remained, dangerous if not impossible; their
ambitions led to the Albert Hall and the terraced rows of the
great towns rather than to the Garden Cities.
Yet it is too often forgotten that the backcloth was almost a
necessity of the pre-Leica age, that the Charge of the Light
Brigade was led by an officer in corsets, and that the closing
decades of the last century were die great years not only of the
local debating society, but also of the Natural History Club. The
"indoorness" ofthe period is in fact merely a part ofthe Victorian
fafade, a popular erection vigorously strengthened during the
last half-century; through its chinks one has seen, too often, onlycaricatures of the men who wrestled with problems far more
difficult than those of today yet who still succeeded in regardingthe world "steadily and whole".
The Victorians were not, of course, at all like their caricatures.
It is true that they were solid and usually sober; yet they had
other qualities, certain inbuilt strengths, which are illuminated
most brilliantly of all by the records of the mountaineers among
15
them, that eccentric, colourful galaxy of oppositeswho formed
the Alpine community which grew during the second half of the
nineteenth century. These men, almost without exception, were
more than mental giants; they were original, enterprising,
adventurous, and tough. They were also phenomenal workers.
Just consider what sort of men and women they were.
Consider Edward Shirley Kennedy, left a fortune by his father
at the age of sixteen he sometimes climbed with his man-
servant Fortunatus following as dutifully close behind as he dared
who for a while lived with thieves and garrotters,who tramped
with similar companions from London to Brighton, and who
was remembered by one persistent question which he voiced more
frequently than any other "Is it right?" Consider Meta Brevoort,
the stern new woman of the age, beating the donkey-drivers if
they ill-treated their animals, ample both offigure and of dignity,
yet singing the "Marseillaise" on the top of Mont Blanc in the
days of the Second Empire and then dancing a quadrille with her
guides. Consider William Grahame, that ill-starred adventurer
who disappeared from the Victorian scene without reason and
who was last heard of as a cowboy in the Far West, a man of
whom it might truly have been written that :
Change was his mistress, Chance his councillor,
Love could not hold him, Dutyforged no chain;
The wide seas and the mountains called to him,
Andgrey dawns saw his camp-fire in the rain.
Consider Miss Straton, the .4,ooo-a-year woman who mar-
ried her guide; or benign C. E. Mathews, organising a six-course
meal followed by coffee and liqueurs in the most desolate and
ill-equipped of Alpine huts. All these characters a fair word for
them represented strong forces which were at work in the age
which created, in the Alpine world, a microcosm of itself.
For it is almost true to claim that if there had been no Victorian
Age there would today be no Alpine Club, none of the hundred
mountaineering groups which are scattered through Britain, few
of the many thousand volumes of mountain exploration which
line the booksellers' shelves.
16
"All the thought of the age arose out of the circumstances of
the age", G. M. Trevelyan has written of the Victorian period.
So did mountaineering, the sport which during the 1 850*5 and
i86o's took a relatively small number of the Victorians upmost of the hitherto virgin summits of the Alps and enabled them
to gain, in a few glorious years of triumph, the laurels which
continental travellers had been eyeing for nearly a quarter of a
century.
The thoroughness ofthe record, which in Alpine statistics has the
quality of an exhibition catalogue, is typical. Nothing less would
have satisfied the exacting standards of the people concerned.
How did it happen? What were the "circumstances ofthe age"which made the rise of mountaineering so nearly inevitable a
century ago?
They were very varied, and the lack, or misplacing, ofany one
ofthem might well have meant the failure of the business to blaze
up as it did. There had first to be the preparatory work of such
people as Forbes, the scientist; of John Ruskin, the man whostartled people's minds into thinking about mountains in a new
way; of that queer mountain-propagandist, Albert Smith. There
had to be a demand for physical knowledge which would drive
scientists up above the snowline even though they might not, at
first, see much attraction in mountains as such. There had to be
a long peaceful period of economic well-being which made such
excursions not only desirable but also possible. And there had to
be some such range as the Alps, conveniently situated at the end
of the carriage roads and only some couple of days distant from
London. All these were prerequisites for the development of
mountaineering by British climbers during the middle of the
Victorian century.
Yet there had to be something more. Strangely enough mendo not go to the hills regularly for conquest alone. They may gothere first to solve some scientific problem. They may go there
to feel for a while the cool keen finger ofdanger pointing at them.
They may even go because it is fashionable to do so. But to
climb continuously, season after season, to think of mountains
and mountaineering so that the subject becomes halfof one's life,
V.M. 2 17
to treat the sport thus, as did many climbers during the latter
half of the last century for all this to happen means that the
attraction must have some deeper and less material reason behind it.
Many minor reasons can be given in an effort to explain howit was that a few hundred lawyers, doctors, scientists, clergymenand merchants were willing to leave their well-servanted homes
for the ragged bivouacs under the colder ifmore inspiring panoplyof the Alpine stars. None of them are completely satisfactory.
The most usual explanation is that the Victorian mountaineers
were over-fed with wealth, ease and luxury; they had, runs the
argument, to get away from it all for one reason or the other.
They were, in a manner ofspeaking, the real Ivory Tower gentle-
men for at least a few weeks every year. Alternatively, they were
salving their consciences in the Alps, finding something in the
mountain world that might redress the balance of the factory
world in which, even if they worked twelve hours a day, theyworked under circumstances vastly different from those of their
less fortunate employees.This physical, Marxian, explanation is correct so far as it goes.
The material advances of the Victorian years, it is true, not only
gave men the craving for hard physical exercise under the sky but
also enabled them to reach the Alps with an ease and speed which
astonished them.
Yet there is another and more important explanation of the
restless mountain-urge which rippled through the Victorian years.
It might be the material circumstances of the age which enabled
men to climb mountains with a facility never before known; it
was something more than this which kept bringing them back
year after year.
The Victorians were always asking questions and they climbed,
fundamentally, because they wanted their questions answered,
They were questions of two sorts and they were asked most
frequently by different, and at times diametrically opposed, groupsof people. It is no coincidence that scientists and clergymen wereso numerous among the early mountaineers.
It was natural that the scientists, the men who wanted physical
questions answered in some detail, should be the first who travelled
18
above the snowline with any regularity. After 1815, travel
throughout Europe became less difficult, and at the same time
science began to push its boundaries far beyond those of the
earlier century. The new enquirers began to ask why it was that
one began to pant and gasp at a great altitude. Could birds or
insects live above the heights at which snow lasted throughout the
year? How and why did the glaciers, those white dragons of the
eighteenth-century prints, move in just the way that they did
move?
Such questions had, of course, been asked before, notably bySaussure, the Genevese whose offer of a reward to be given to the
first man to reach the top ofMont Blanc, directly led to its ascent
in 1786. There had been other scientific mountaineers who had
followed, almost literally, in his footsteps while there had, before
the Victorians, been a number ofmen and women, many ofthem
British, whose mountain travels had been unhampered by anyscientific ambitions. Mrs. and Miss Campbell, two of the earliest
British women mountain-travellers, had crossed the Col du Geant
in the Mont Blanc range in the early 1 820'$. William Brockedon,the writer and traveller who helped John Murray produce the
first edition of his famous handbook to Switzerland, had crossed
the Theodule in the Pennines in 1825, and a number of other
glacier passes in 1828 and 1829. Francis Walker, who in 1865
took part in the famous first ascent of the Brenva ridge on the
south side of Mont Blanc at the age of fifty-seven, crossed the
Theodule in the same year as Brockedon; two years later
Frederick Slade and Yeats Brown made an enterprising attemptto climb the Jungfrau with nine guides.
Yet all these exploits were isolated examples ofjoie de vivre.
They aided only slightly in building up any permanent know-
ledge ofhigh mountain travel; they had little or no effect beyonda small select circle of personal acquaintances; and they provided
relatively little opportunity for what contemporary writers call
"the mountain magic" to get to work.
It was only when men began to climb in the mountains regu-
larly rather than spasmodically that the situation was altered.
These men were the scientists. For to secure answers to the
19
questions which they had set themselves to solve they had to
climb regularly. It was necessary for them to be out and about
not only in fair weather but in the full blast of the mountain
storm; it was necessary for them to camp, to train and hire guides
who could carry their delicate instruments with some approachto safety, to build up a technique oftravel above the snowline and
to produce a demand for better inns below it. The men of science
acquired, in order to keep both their scientific wits about them
and their lives intact, the first rules of mountain travel.
It is interesting to remember that those who today seek out the
last technical secrets of the Himalaya, the Hindu Kush or the
Karakoram and who, almost incidentally as it were, resolve in a
new way the problems of high Asiatic travel, had their counter-
parts in pioneers such as Forbes, Tyndall, Bonney, Ramsey, and
other scientists who pressed ever more deeply into the Alps duringthe forties and fifties of the last century.
There are two points to note in connection with these Victorians
who went mountaineering to solve their scientific problems,
points which have a bearing on the apparently materialist theoryof mountaineering-impulse. The first is the large number of
scientists who came to study and stayed to worship. Forbes, whose
ponderous glacier argument rumbled round the universities for
decades, finished by becoming as great a mountain addict as
Ruskin (and, it might be said, not such a very different kind of
addict). Tyndall, who when it came to writing could rarely
disentangle his mountain-worship from the trails of Royal Insti-
tution prose, built his "London5 '
house at Hindhead where the
mists can summon up the mountain glory as easily as anywhereelse in the world, and later made his spiritual home in the little
and almost unbelievably ugly house at Alp Lusgen. Bonney,whose geological researches took him into die Dauphine nearlya decade before Whymper went there, was captured not only bythe record of the rocks but also by the mountain scene. Ramsaybecame attached to the mountains ofSnowdonia with an affection
that was by no means scientific.
The second interesting point is that so many of these scientists,
who found in the mountains something that was apparently more
20
than the answers to their scientific conundrums, were in fact
geologists. They were, in other words, men whose daily life and
thought brought them into full and unavoidable contact with the
awful problems posed by the revelations of this science which
was then eating so deeply into many men's accepted beliefs. The
geologists had done more than any other group ofmen to under-
mine man's ancient belief in the certainty of the Universe and in
a life everlasting; it would be easy to maintain that in that fact
lay the real seed of mountain-worship when immortality goes,
hold fast to the magnificent certainties of mountain-form and
mountain-beauty.Yet the geologists were no more prominent than the clergy,
the gentlemen who were doing their best to maintain a belief in
the cosmology which the awkward scientists were destroying
with an unnerving ease. This apparent paradox of the wolf and
the lamb setting out, so to speak, on the same Alpine expedition,
is most illuminating. It shows what might have been expectedfrom the circumstances, that they both climbed for very similar
reasons.
Perhaps it is not so very surprising. Many of the clergymen of
a hundred years ago had become rather too near to God. Theyunderstood the codified business of religion down to the last
"Amen"; they were supremely confident of their position on the
Almighty's right hand; they were able to give the answers so
easily that in many cases religion had become more a matter of
good cross-indexing than of basic belief. Knowledge had come
in at the window and humility had flown out at the door. That
was the outward form of affairs; a form in which Sunday prayers
at the Bel Alp, the little inn which had been opened on the
magnificent vantage-point above the Aletsch glacier in the Ober-
land, gave a good and well-earned advantage in the life to come
over such men as the guides who occasionally lapsed into believing
that there were, after all, really "ghosts on the Matterhorn".
The form lacked nothing except the essential mystery. ManyVictorian Churchmen realised the fact. And, after the physical
circumstances of the age had persuaded them up into the moun-
tains, they found on them some hint of this mystic and needed
21
link between themselves and the unexplained and the inexplicable.
What is more, they found that it gave to their mortal work a new
and hard proselytising punch.The geologists were in much the same way. They, too, had
begun to explain everything far too satisfactorily. They, too,
though in a different way, needed to get out beyond the slick
certainties of life to the point where doubt arose. In their case
it was not so much a question of religious belief as an intellectual
problem posed by expanding knowledge which was the difficulty;
yet with them, also, the climbing of difficult mountains restored
the balance. The academic as well as the physical and spiritual
problems they found gave them back their necessary unknown
and made them complete men once again.
Few of these climbers, either scientists or Churchmen, declared
openly and boldly to the world the full pungent reasons for their
mountaineering. What they did do was to agree that they had
ears attuned to the lesser mysteries. Almost without exception,
they sought "contact with Nature".
The mountaineers carried this practice of experiencing the
rough yet still kindly touch ofnature one logical step farther than
most oftheir contemporaries. This was very right, for they felt the
artificiality of the picnic at the end of the carriage-drive; theyknew not only the limitless suggestions but also the limitations
ofBox Hill and Hindhead, and of the other physically lesser hills
of the world. They realised that to regain something that their
age had lost they had to give genuine hostages to fortune; they
had, at some period in the process, really to stand alone and
battered by the gale with only a fair chance ofgetting home alive.
Nothing less would do.
The Victorian climbers were therefore united in seeing in their
mountain adventures something different from a sport, something
impinging on their thoughts more significantly than any hobbycould ever do, something which was to mould their lives and to
fashion out ofthem such beings that they who climbed mountains
were not in their own opinions at least as other men.This deep spiritual satisfaction which they found in the moun-
tains was, it must be admitted, the only thing that did unite them,
22
Few groups of men joined by a common enthusiasm or belief
have had such varied backgrounds, made such different approachesto the minutiae of their sport, drawn such different pleasures from
a similar set of circumstances, or fought such bitter and unrelent-
ing disputes in urging their own specific points of view. Outside
the bright circle of light cast by the great Alpine disputes they
might be tolerant and liberal-minded and forgiving; inside it
they were uncommonly like the great teachers, each maintainingthat his, alone, was the one route not only up to the gate of the
Kingdom of Heaven but also right through it.
It was not surprising that the Victorian mountaineers should
have argued. They were too many-sided to agree for long on
anything; their interests overflowed into the other fellows' com-
partments, and they all had particular views of their own on
everything. Many, such as John Ball and Francis Fox Tuckett,
combined an amateur interest in science with their love of
exploring fresh country; some of the artists,Whymper above all,
wereamong the most enterprising ofthe great climbers; some ofthe
scientists, notablyTyndall, became not onlymountain-worshippersbut pioneers in the craft far ahead of their contemporaries.The reasons that first drove them up into the mountains were
as varied and as intermingled as their interests. The professional
and business men might first climb for mental relaxation: the
scientists might ascend a high peak to analyse the quality of the
air; the clergy might, almost by accident, find in the sublimityof the mountain dawn and sunset, either a confirmation or a
reassurance of those beliefs which their vocation bade them
preach. Yet there were no clear divisions about the matter.
Bonney, the geologist, was also a Clerk in Holy Orders and both
undertakings are reflected in the reasons which drew him to the
mountains. The Rev. Hereford Brooke George, the red-bearded
giant who was to become the first editor of the Alpine Journal,
saw in what he called the climbing spirit both "that love ofaction
for its own sake . . . which has made England the great coloniser
of the world" and also a means by which men could see more
clearly "that above and beyond all law rises the supreme will of
the Almighty lawgiver".
23
Largely because of this intermingling of ideas and the inter-
locking of resultant events, it becomes a major problem tojudge
fairly which group of men exerted the greatest influence on the
sport or drew to it the greatest number of adherents. Does the
great glacier controversy equal in influence Albert Smith's "Mont
Blanc Sideshow" which earned him nearly .30,000? Do either
equal the influence ofRuskin's fourth volume ofModern Painters?
Men not only began climbing for a multiplicity of reasons, once
the "circumstances of the age" allowed; they continued to climb
for an equally large and varied number of reasons.
These Victorian climbers are slightly surprising in two different
ways. They were not all wealthy. And they were astonishingly
tough.Some were, it is true, born with a canteen of silver spoons in
their mouths. Others, were like Thomas Atkinson, admitted to
the select Alpine Club even though he had been born "ofhumble
origin, became a bricklayer's labourer and quarryman, and later
a stonemason and carver". It is too often forgotten that Tyndall,
the poor Irishman from County Carlow, first saw the Alps on a
student's walking tour which he "got through amazingly cheap";that Whymper was by no means well-to-do when he first went
to the Alps as an engraver for Longman, the book publisher; and
that many ofthe less well-endowed Churchmen who played such
a prominent part in Victorian mountaineering only did so throughthe use ofthe cheaper pension wherever possible and of the packed
diligence. Even the Coolidges, superficially among the richest of
travellers, touring with their caravanserai of Christian Aimer,
"young Christian", one or more porters and the immortal bitch
Tschingel, at times had to cut their travel according to their
finances. It was by no means all carriages and champagne.What is more, when one considers the development of the
sport, a development worked up into a great movement by the
yeast ofa strong spiritual need, one ofthe most astonishing thingsis that the Victorians were tough enough to do what they did.
James David Forbes, the scholarly retiring invalid who was
in many ways an eighteenth-century gentleman born rather too
late, wrote a revealing paragraph late in life when the burden of
24
disease and overwork was already hanging heavily on his
shoulders. "He who does not feel his step lighter and his breath
freer on the Montanvert and the Wengern Alp, may be classed
among the incapables and permitted to retire in peace to paddlehis skiffon the Lake of Geneva or to loiter in the salons ofBaden
Baden", he said.
Forbes reminds one of a letter written many years later byEdward Whymper, that giant whose tragedy loomed like a black
shadow behind the Alpine scene for nearly half a century.
Whymper was seventy-one at the time, bad-tempered and
breathless, an old lion ofwhom the younger generation was still
both respectful and cautious. He was explaining to W. A. B.
Coolidge, that pedantic scholar-mountaineer who was inter-
mittently his friend, enemy and possibly father-confessor
how he would again visit one of his old Alpine haunts. "WhenI come, I shall come in the old style", he wrote. "Shall walk up,not order rooms in advance, and take my chance as to finding a
room. Ifnone can be had, I shall camp out."
Whymper was, to the end, aggressive, confident, and lonely,
all natural traits which had been deepened when, as a man of
twenty-five, he had made the first ascent of the reputedly in-
accessible Matterhorn and had then watched four of his com-
panions fall to their death during the descent. It was a tragedyfrom whose effects mountaineering was to recover far more
quickly than did Whymper.Yet in the toughness of his old age he was no exception.
Leslie Stephen was not only the editor ofthe Dictionary ofNational
Biography but one of the forty-mile-a-day men. John Ball, editor
of the Alpine Guide, strode down the scorching Italian valleys
bearing his own pack although he was an Englishman who might
certainly have been expected to employ porters. Forbes, the
invalid, lost his knapsack and crossed the Stelvio on foot with, as
kit and food, just what he could stuff into his pockets. Michael
Faraday, mountain-traveller as well as scientist, walked from
Leukerbad over the Gemmi Pass to Thun, forty-four miles in
ten and a half hours and two hours' rest, in spite of illness. The
Rev. Wethered (roughly known to some as "Botherhead") once
25
described to Coolidge his methods for keeping fit. "I am thankful
to say that I am very fit in health", said this fellow who was the
first man to climb the Matterhorn in a day from Zermatt and
who was then the Vicar of Hurley. "I put this down largely to
the Alps, and to bathing in the Thames every morning before
breakfast in residence, winter as well as summer. I am just off to
bathe now." The date was October 28, 1910; Wethered's age,
seventy years, nine months.
Such men were typical Victorians, many of whom had a
toughness which would probably reveal itself surprisingly well
on a Commando course, even though the gentlemen concerned
would go through the business in stovepipe trousers, keep their
hands clean, and ask a few pertinent and probably awkward
questions.
The field of their adventures was primitive in a way which it
is difficult to imagine today. Adams-Reilly, the amiable Irish
gentleman whose lovely map ofMont Blanc carried on thework of
Forbes, once wrote of the Alpine world into which Forbes had
penetrated in the 1 840*5, a world not so very different from that
which saw the end of the Golden Age. "Legends of air too
rarefied to support life, and of avalanches started by the human
voice, still lingered among the crags the 'trailing skirts' of that
departed night of superstition which had before peopled them
with dragons and chimeras", he said.
The railway came to this shadowy land only in 1844, when the
first tracks were laid in Switzerland; there were then only a fewmiles ofthem and in 1857, the year in which the Alpine Club was
founded, no railways really entered the mountain zone. Depositedat the railway terminus of the lowland belt, the traveller boundfor the Alps had for the next stage of the journey the choice of
carriage, too dear except for the moderately wealthy, or the
packed diligence. Even these sources of transport petered out in
the mountain zone, with the exception of those few whichfollowed the carriage routes across the great passes into Italy,
leaving the mountain aspirant with the choice of travelling onfoot or of bargaining personally with the muleteers.
In his inns, the Victorian mountaineer fared little better.
26
Bonney, writing of the i86o's, says cryptically: "Fresh meat
could not be obtained, the bread and wine alike were sour; vermin
abounded." Fleas provided an almost inexhaustible supply both
of annoyance and of Alpine humour, and one feels at times that
old Semiond, in his remarks to Whymper, had almost the right
attitude, and at least the most philosophic one. "I am no different
from anyone else", he confidently said of the subject. "I have
them."
It was in the Dauphine that conditions, both of travel and of
accommodation, were worst. Here, even at the end ofthe Golden
Age, lay a great area of high virgin country, a land off the maintrack of Franco-Italian travellings, a land traversed by few roads
and those ill-kept for wheeled traffic; a country where even the
huts of goitrous peasants were frequently better habitation than
the inns; a strange dominion in which the heights ofmany of the
great peaks were still cloaked in an obscurity not so very different
from that of the Middle Ages. Even as late as 1870, when
Coolidge and his aunt came down from the Aiguilles d'Arves into
the Romanche Valley, that frontier of the Dauphine, they found
La Grave, although a lovely place, ablaze with flowers ofevery hue,
almost completely lacking in what would now be called amenities.
The floor of our room was as black as the ace of spades [wroteMiss Brevoort to her sister], a bag of flour and a sieve in one corner.
No means of washing apparent, flowers spread out to dry on the
floor, no pillows, sheets like dish-cloths! Will went to bed while his
clothes were drying and, concluding it was the best place for him,
remained there ! We made some tea and had boiled eggs, but neither
milk nor butter as the cows are away. Fleas without end!
Throughout most of the Alpine regions, the pioneers were
served by maps that were at the worst unreliable and at the best
so laughably inadequate that they could not seriously be used.
The first explorers of the Dauphine, who came little more than a
decade before Coolidge and his aunt, were forced to use Bour-
cett's map of 1749-1754; a map drawn only a few years after the
days of Scheuchzer who seriously listed the various species of
dragons to be found in the Alps.
27
During these days ofmountaineering genesis, the period duringwhich the comfortable homes of Britain were left in search of
some new mystic Grail, collecting boxes for cretins, the grotes-
quely goitrous, still hung in the larger Alpine inns. Men not only
spoke, but spoke in careful words, ofthe giants who dwelt amongthe thunder of the peaks. Some spirit of the eighteenth centurystill hung like the gauzy mists of dawn above a world where the
safe return of a traveller from the heights was the signal for a
Guide-Chef, that autocrat of the guides' association, to prepare
specially written testimonials, for the local innkeeper to summonstaff for the victory banquet, and for servants to touch off the
cannons which still roared out to tell the valley ofsuch a triumphalevent.
It was into this remote world of the day before yesterday that
the Victorians strode, half conquerors, half pilgrims, walking
examples of both the success and the dissatisfaction of their ownenormous age.
28
Chapter One
THE PROPHETSWe are the music-makers,
And we are the dreamers ofdreams.
Wandering by lone sea-breakers,
And sitting by desolate streams;
World-losers and world-forsakers,
On whom the pale moon gleams:Yet we are the movers and shakers
Of the worldfor ever, it seems.
ARTHUR WILLIAM EDGAR O'SHAUGHNESSY
A?the beginning of the Victorian Age the Swiss had been
climbing their own mountains for a number of years. The
Meyers who ascended theJungfrau in 1811 and the Finsteraarhorn
the following year, the Hugis, the Studers and the Ulrichs these
are only some of the Swiss who climbed the high peaks of the
Alps before the growth of the Victorian mountaineer. Yet each
man's achievements remained an isolated series of sparks. TheSwiss tinder, unlike the British variety of the 1850*5 and i86o's,
was not the stuff to blaze up. Each individual enthusiast merely
glowed for a while in the small circle of his own personal con-
quests.
Before such isolated episodes could blaze up into a conflagra-
tion, three essential requirements had to be met. There had first
to be a spiritual preparation, the making of an apologia which
would enable men to regard mountains neither as areas of dangerand terror nor as roseate, pink-and-white paradises where
Rousseau-like peasants danced in perpetual good weather. Before
mountaineering could reach full stature, the mountains themselves
had to be given a new place in the Universe, a place not onlywhere man could walk calmly close to God but where he could,
as Frederic Harrison wrote to his daughter, "know nothing and
29
feel nothing, but that he is a marvellous atom in a marvellous
world".
Secondly, the technique ofmountain travel had to be built up.
The best methods ofmoving on different types of snow and ice,
the safety measures to be observed in this virtually unknown
world, the peculiar physiological problems that presented them-
selves all these had to be enquired into by men entering a world
as little known and almost as forbidding as that of the thin blue
haze of outer space which awaits the explorers of today.
Thirdly, the existence of this world above the snowline had
to be made known to more than a small handful of specialist
adventurers.
These tasks were carried out by three men who even in their
own day would have made little claim to genuine mountain
prowess. Only with difficulty can two of them be classed as
"mountaineers", in the contemporary sense of the word. Yet
without them the charge built up by the middle of the nineteenth
century might possibly have exploded not into mountaineeringbut into some hitherto unsuspected and possibly less harmless
enterprise. These men were John Ruskin, the writer and art
critic, James David Forbes, the scientist, and Albert Smith, the
playwright, journalist, and creator ofthe "Mont Blanc" entertain-
ment which he produced in the Egyptian Hall, Piccadilly, com-
plete with Swiss misses, gaudily painted backcloths, and genuineSt. Bernard dogs, one of which struck fear into Queen Victoria
when it was later presented to the infant Prince ofWales.
The whole mountain world which expanded, set-piece-like, in
the 1840*8 and 1850*5, and which grew during the subsequent
years of the century, was illuminated by the writings, the sayings,
the influence, ofJohn Ruskin, the sheltered, careful, exponent of
mountain beauty who was the protected son of a wealthysuburban wine-merchant. It was almost a mixed blessing.
Ruskin was one of the first writers to believe that mountain
scenery had something to offer the human race, and as his
writings gained influence he expounded the fact with increasing
vigour. His belief was summed up early, in the famous fourth
volume ofModern Painters.
30
But loveliness of colour, perfectness ofform, endlessness ofchange,wonderfulness of structure, are precious to all undiseased human
minds; and the superiority ofthe mountains in all these things to the
lowland is, I repeat, as measurable as the richness of a paintedwindow matched with a white one, or the wealth of a museum
compared with that of a simply furnished chamber. They seem to
have been built for the human race, as at once their schools and
cathedrals; full oftreasures ofilluminated manuscript for the scholar,
kindly in simple lessons to the worker, quiet in pale cloisters for the
thinker, glorious in holiness for the worshipper.
Here, indeed, was an attitude diametrically opposed to that of
Master John de Bremble, the medieval monk who after crossing
the Great Saint Bernard prayed: "Lord, restore me to mybrethren, that I may tell them that they come not to this place of
torment." Here, with no mistake, was a man who was producinga good logical reason for going up into the mountains. As
Ruskin's influence increased throughout the long Victorian reign,
so did he score and underscore the lesson.
Many of the thoughtful mountaineering disciples who slipped
through the gate that Ruskin, almost alone, had carefully pushed
open for them, have acknowledged how much they owed to this
pale-faced young man who was in most ways the antithesis of all
mountaineers.
I owe him a personal debt [wrote Leslie Stephen]. Many peoplehad tried their hands upon Alpine descriptions since Saussure, but
Ruskin's chapters seemed to have the freshness of a new revelation.
The fourth volume of Modern Painters infected me and other
members of the Alpine Club with an enthusiasm for which, I hope,we are still grateful.
Douglas Freshfield, himself an equal to Stephen in the Alpine
hierarchy, claimed that no one had added so much as Ruskin to
the enjoyment of mountain scenery.
It is a little disappointing after all this to learn one disconcerting
fact; that although Ruskin travelled through the Alps for a great
number of seasons many of them at the height of mountain-
eering's Golden Age and although he had ample leisure and
sufficient money, yet he only climbed one mountain, the
31
io,i64-ft. Buet. It is even more disappointing to record that the
experience forced him to the conclusion that "the Alps were, on
the whole, best seen from below".
This is only the beginning of the case against Ruskin. There is
also, on the debit side, the famous jibe about "soaped poles" with
which he castigated at least certain types of mountain-climber.
Later, he was to write of:
the extreme vanity of the modern Englishman in making a momen-
tary Stylites of himself on the top of a Horn or an Aiguille, and his
occasional confession of a charm in the solitude of the rocks, of
which he modifies nevertheless the poignancy with his pocket
newspaper, and from the prolongation of which he thankfully
escapes to the nearest table-d'hote.
This attitude condoned if not understood, it is too easy to
regard Ruskin as a mountain Plazo-Toro, an Alpine general
leading his troops from behind. Most of the evidence does
suggest that he failed to climb because he disliked the hardshipand was afraid of getting hurt; or, perhaps more charitably,
because he did not think worth while the risks of getting hurt
which would, in his own inexpert judgement, have to be faced
above the snowline. Yet to agree that Ruskin stood merely on
the touch-lines of real mountaineering is in no way to belittle his
effect. He helped in the essential task of clearing away the
medieval undergrowth so that men ofgood will might regard the
mountains "steadily and whole". That he, himself, did not press
on regardless with the next job of personally discovering the
mountains makes his influence on the Alpine world, so great, so
vital, and so lasting, all the more remarkable. Had he appreci-ated to the full his effectiveness in the primary task, he would no
doubt have been satisfied. The second task was not merely be-
yond him; it was no part ofhis business.
John Ruskin, born in London of well-to-d wS in 1819,
inherited the tradition of slow, well-ordered summer journeysacross Europe. He made the first at the age offourteen, the second
32
5 Charles Hudson 6 John Bali, first President of the
Alpine Club
7 John Tyndall
two years later, the third at the age of twenty-three, and the
fourth at the age of twenty-five.From the first he appears to have looked on the Alps, as he
later wrote of all mountains, as "the beginning and end of all
natural scenery". As he travelled through them, year after year,
observing, recording, questioning, sketching, enquiring ever
more deeply into their geological structure and their purpose in
life, Ruskin began to build up in his own mind a picture of the
mountains in which they formed a background not merely to one
particular set of experiments but to all worthwhile existence. It
was this many-sidedness of his approach which was of such
importance. For it meant that one could have a legitimate interest
in the mountains without being either a naturalist or a geologist.
During the i84o's, in which Ruskin's earlier travels were made,
the Alps were still largely the province ofthe scientific mountain-
traveller. Ruskin did not object to this. One of his ambitions
was to become President of the Geological Society; he planned
many of his rambles with one eye on the strata; he was an
inveterate collector of specimens. Yet be believed that a man
among mountains should be something more than a mere
collector, and he puffed his wrath at those who believed other-
wise.
There is a fine satirical passage in his Chronicles of St. Bernard
which illustrates this early attitude and which might almost have
been written by Leslie Stephen three decades later.
In his semi-fictitious description, Ruskin tells how the pro-fession of a young Englishman is proclaimed by his collection of
"those worthless and ugly bits of chucky stones which, dignified
by the name of 'specimens5
, become in the eyes of a certain class
of people, of such inestimable value".
Together with Ruskin, the young man watches the sunset
above the mountains near Courmayeur.
A few rosy clouds were scattered on the heaven, or wrapped about
their bases, but their summits rose pure and glorious, just beginningto get rosy in the afternoon sun and here and there a red peak of
bare rock rose up into the blue out ofthe snowy mantle.
"How beautiful", I said to my companion, "those peaks of rock
V.M. 3 35
rise into the heaven like promontories running out into the deep
deep blue of some transparent ocean."
"Ah yes, brown, limestone strata vertical, or nearly so, dip
eighty-rive and a half", replied the geologist.
Such was almost the sacred attitude to mountain travel when
Ruskin began to startle the professors into opening their eyes.
There are few better portraits of the attitude adopted by at least
some of the scientists although few went so far as this one whomade a point of chipping specimens off the nearby gravestones.
Yet it was not the geological approach but the geological
approach unallied to anything wider, more humane, or more
artistic, that rankled with Ruskin. He could chip and analyse
with the best ofthem, but he saw the mountains as illustrations of
something more than the mere physical facts of life that menwere then discovering for the first time. It was thus that he could
look with bewilderment rather than awe at the Darwinian
theses which later in life so wracked his contemporaries. His
reaction to the scientific approach to the mountains was in this
respect curiously modern. He was at one, in this matter at least,
not only with Leslie Stephen who drove Tyndall to resignation
from the Alpine Club by a famous bantering after-dinner speechbut also with such men as Lord Schuster, Winthrop Young,
Smythe, Tilman and Shipton.
For Ruskin, the mountains were examples of God's handiwork
and in moving among them man could learn to discover himself.
Tttis attitude, which permeated almost all that he wrote, is
expressed most clearly of all in his verdict on Forbes.
Many an Alpine traveller, many a busy man of science, volubly
represent to us their pleasures in the Alps [he wrote], but I scarcely
recognise one who would not willingly see them all ground downinto gravel, on the condition ofhis being the first to exhibit a pebbleof it at the Royal Institution. Whereas it may be felt in any single
page of Forbes* writing, or de Saussure's, that they love crag and
glacier for their own sake's sake; that they question their secrets in
reverent and solemn thirst; not at all that they may communicatethem at breakfast to the readers ofthe Daily Newstti& that althoughthere were no news, no institutions, no leading articles, no medals,
36
no money, and no mob, in the world, these men would still labour
and be glad, though all their knowledge was to rest with them at
last in the silence of the snows, or only to be taught to peasantchildren sitting in the shade of the pines.
All Ruskin's influence on man's appreciation of mountains,
which developed steadily throughout the latter half of the
Victorian era, lies in what he wrote rather than in what he did,
for the truth is that he did very little. Yet wherever he travelled
he wrote. He wrote copiously, at times pompously, at times
magnificently, but across whole oceans of his prose there sails the
message that mountains provide fine, uplifting, thought-provok-
ing sights. For nearly half a century Ruskin used this message to
erode the slowly disappearing belief that mountain areas were
areas of horror and ugliness and danger. For that, all men are
perpetually in his debt.
Yet although Ruskin's emphasis on what mountains mightmean to man remained constant throughout his whole life, his
estimate of how they might best be "used" was a perpetually
changing one; changing, it appears, not steadily in one direction
or the other as he grew older but from year to year, without
apparent rhyme or reason. His reaction to "sporting" mountain-
eering and the formation of the Alpine Club is typical; essays on
Ruskin and the Mountains are almost equally divided between
those which paint him in avuncular colours and those which list
his outbursts against the Club. Much of his disgust that the
mountains were being used "as soaped poles in a bear-gardenwhich you set yourselves to climb and slide down again with
'shrieks of delight'"
appears to have stemmed from one unfor-
tunate fact; that he was at Chamonix when Albert Smith returned,
amid cannon-banging and with great exultation, from his much-
publicised ascent of Mont Blanc. Much of his criticism would
have been justified had it been aimed as it well may have been
not at the genuine mountaineers but at their imitators. Andit must be remembered that in 1868 Ruskin attended the Winter
Dinner of the Alpine Club, joined the Club a year later his
qualification being authorship of the fourth volume of Modern
Painters created an excellent impression, and planned writing a
37
paper on Alpine Art for tie AlpineJournal Yet the contradiction
remains; psychologically he stood always on the edge of the
mountains.
He wandered extensively below the snowline. He looked about
him with eyes that were more widely open than those of many
genuine mountaineers who followed him. And occasionally he
burst out with an exultation which suggests those better tilings
which never came. He rushes out into the dawn of St. Jean de
Maurienne seeking, may one imagine, that great, grave, out-
line of the Aiguille d'Arves? and records:
Thank God! I have lost none ofmy oldjoy in the Alps. I dressed
in three minutes, and rushed out down through the galleried village
and up on the cattle path among the dewy rich pasture, the blaze
of the snow on every side, the rocks clean against the heaven, and
red and steep, and my eyes strangely well able to meet the full blaze
of the western pyramid without shrinking. Oh, happy! I shall
never forget this morning unless my brains go altogether, and even
then the sound of its cattle-bells would ring in them.
Consider what the record implies the record of a man with
his heart set in the right place and a genuine feeling for the
heights.
Yet at the not-so-ripe age of fifty-four when many moun-taineers may well expect to be at the height of their power this
same lover of the Alps jumps into battle at Leslie Stephen's
suggestion that Whymper had "taught us[i.e.
the members ofthe
Alpine Club] for the first time really to see the mountains".
Ruskin came in at this suggestion with all professional hackles
fully raised.
Believe me, gentlemen [he told an Oxford audience], your powerof seeing mountains cannot be developed either by your vanity,
your curiosity, or your love of muscular exercise. It depends on the
cultivation of the instrument of sight itself, and of the sense that
causes it. ...
For, gentlemen, little as you may think it, you can no more see
the Alps from the Col du Geant, or the top of the Matterhorn, than
the pastoral scenery of Switzerland from the railroad carriage. If
you want to see the skeleton of the Alps, you may go to Zermatt
38
or Chamouni; but if you want to see the body and soul of the
Alps, you must stay awhile among the Jura, and in the Bernese
Plain; leave alpenstocks to be flourished in each other's faces, and
between one another's legs, by Cook's tourists, and try to find some
companionship in yourself with yourself; and not to be dependentfor your good cheer either on the gossip of the table d'hote, or the
hail-fellow and well met, hearty though it be, ofeven the pleasantest
of celebrated guides.
Here, perhaps, is the clue to Ruskin's failing.For he could only
look at alpenstocks and guides with the eyes of ignorance. Al-
though he had opened the door to the Alps, he never had the
courage to pass through that door himseif. It was partly, of
course, the result of his parents' crippling care. It may also have
been influenced by the fact that the guide chosen to accompanyRuskin on his Alpine rambles was Joseph Marie Couttet, one of
the few survivors of the disastrous accident to Dr. HameFs partyon Mont Blanc in 1820. Couttet no doubt talked about the
accident; the incident was fresh enough, and vivid enough, to
form the subject of Ruskin's poem "The Avalanche"; and it
seems possible that the story of this tragedy so worked itself into
the mind of the impressionable Ruskin that almost all highmountain travel appeared to him as overshadowed by almost
inevitable death and disaster. Some such abnormal working ofthe
mind is needed to explain his genuine beliefthat, as he put it, "the
real beauty of the Alps is to be seen, and seen only, where all maysee it, the child, the cripple, and the man ofgrey hairs".
The truth is that there was something twisted and something
lacking in Ruskin and, as always, the touchstone ofthe mountains
revealed the fact. "All the best views of hills are at the bottom of
thfcm", he writes and, immediately, one knows what sort of a
man Ruskin is. The tragedy is what he might have been. For
what might not have happened had Ruskin escaped early from
the hitherings and thitherings of his wretched parents? What
might not have happened had he broken out from the careful
round of mountain rambles and chanced himself so that he saw
the Alps not from without but from within? His eye for
mountain form might have led him higher on to the mountains
V.M. 3* 39
than any other man of his generation;his prose might have
thundered in the Alpine Journal to good effect.
All this was not to be. And, in spite of the fact, Ruskin still
towers as the first, and possiblythe greatest,
mountain prophet
ofthe age. He made men look at mountains. He made them talk
about mountains and think about mountains. He was the man at
the lock-gate turning the wheel to let the first trickle of water
through. And it is part of his tragedy that he would have agreed
with Martin Conway, that epitome of all the later Victorian
mountaineers, who once wrote that "each generation makes of
the world more or less the kind of place they dream it should be;
and each when its day is done is often in a mood to regret the
work of its own hands and to praise the conditions that obtained
when it was young".* if *
However well Ruskin might have presented the fine mental
case for mountain-appreciation, little would have come of it had
not the mechanics of mountain-travel also been investigated in
equal detail.
It was James David Forbes, the tall unassuming professor of
Edinburgh University, moving through the early Alpine world
with the last ruffle ofhis cuffs in place, who performed this task. He
made mountaineering possible,just as Ruskin made it worthwhile.
Enquiring, courteous, well-to-do, deeply moved by religion,
crippled in early life by illness yet retaining until death a genuine
love of mountains and mountain-travel, Forbes was in almost
every respect the text-book opposite of that later climbing
scientist, John Tyndall. He provides, chronologically, the link
between the world of Saussure and the world of the Victorian
mountaineers. He provides, psychologically, an ideal example of
the transformation which so often took place in those scientists
who came to the mountains to study and who stayed to worship.
And he provides, in dozens of small incidents which stand out
from his stern scientific accounts, examples of the wonder and
exhilaration which came to men when they first realised the
sporting possibilities of the Alps.
40
Forbes, born in 1809, acquired from his father, who kept a
town house in Edinburgh and a country house at Colinton, at
least enough money for careful travel; and although always busy,
working at new experiments until they finally broke his health,
he was aided in his mountain-explorations by the old Scottish
University system which crowded the year's work into six
months and left the other six in each year free for travel.
His first sight of the mountains came at the age of sixteen whenhe was taken on the conventional Grand Tour, visiting Inns-
bruck, Vienna, Rome, Naples, and Chamonix, and precociously
sending anonymous papers to the Edinburgh Philosophical Journal.
The publication was under the editorship of the renowned Sir
David Brewster, who printed the papers under the illusion that
they must be from some distinguished and original-minded manofscience.
On this first visit to the Alps, Forbes was led to the Montanvert,
the sunny belvedere above die Mer de Glace, by no less a guidethan Cachat le Geant, one ofthose who had accompanied Saussure
on his famous ascent; for Forbes, already cultivating his genius for
observing, recording, deducing, it must have been as though
good fortune had now given him another link with the master.
And, like the master, he decided first to establish himself in life
and then to spend a part of each summer on the Continent,
touring "not as an amusement but as a serious occupation". Hehad not long to wait, rocketing into prominence, becoming a
Fellow of the Royal Society at the age oftwenty-three and beingelected to the Chair of Natural Philosophy at Edinburgh the
following year. The post was no sinecure. He travelled to
London, to Cambridge, to Oxford, to meet other men of science
working in the same fields as himself and to discuss with them the
various problems on which they were mutually at work. Hetook lessons in elocution from Mrs. Siddons so that his lecturing
might be improved, and he generally swung himselfinto the busyroutine of professorial life. His mountain travels would, he
planned, form an essential part of it.
All of them and they continued until stopped by ill health
were imbued by the same unusual mixture of intellectual
observation and emotional enjoyment. In many ways, Forbes, like
Arnold later in the century, saw all life "steadily and whole". His
philosophy of mountain-travel, his conception of the place which
it should occupy both in scientific observation and in the happy
life, is illustrated by one passage from his Travels through the Alps
ofSavoy > one ofthose books which sparked the imagination ofthe
generation which later consolidated the Alpine Club.
Mere change of scene and active exercise produce fatigue at last,
unless the mind have some wholesome employment as well as the
body [he wrote]. And most of those who have made the trial will
probably regard as amongst the happiest periods of their lives those
in which a favourite study has been pursued in the retirement of
mountain scenery. Mornings of active exercise, from sunrise till
afternoon, and evenings of quiet thought and speculation, with
here and there a day interposed of easy society with intelligent
travellers, or employed in reducing and digesting the knowledge
previously acquired by observation, give the sense of living twice
over. Happy the traveller who, content to leave to others the gloryof counting the thousands of leagues of earth and ocean they have
left behind them, established in some mountain shelter with his
books, starts on bis first day's walk amongst the Alps in the tranquil
morning of a long July day, brushing the early dew before him,
and, armed with his staff, makes for the hill-top (begirt with ice
or rock as the case might be), when he sees the field of his summer's
campaign spread out before him, its wonders, its beauties, and its
difficulties, to be explained, to be admired, and to be overcome.
Here is the attitude that Forbes retained throughout life, an
attitude significantly different from that of Ruskin who wouldnever have rubbed his nose on the rocks. Scientists of the next
generation, men such as Tyndall and Bonney, went one step
farther, becoming imbued with the passion for exploration and
climbing as a worthwhile endeavour in its own right. Forbes
always kept to his earlier attitude. Late in life he regretted that
Auguste Balmat, his old guide, was not often employed, and
added: "He would still be invaluable to any man with ever so
slight a tincture of science, such as would prevent him from
scampering from col to peak with an almost insane restlessness/*
The first of his mountain journeys was made in 1835 when he
42
travelled to the Pyrenees to study the geology of the region,
visited the Cirque de Gavarnie and the Breche de Roland, and
watched the glacier waters disappearing into the Trou de Toro.
Two years later he visited the universities of Bonn, Gottingen,
and Berlin, then struck south into Austria, ostensibly to carry out
a number of experiments on terrestrial magnetism. Fortuitously,
his journey took him into the almost unknown area of the Dolo-
mites where he saw, with amazed eyes, the rocky pinnacles of the
Langkofel and the Marmolata groups, and pressed on into a score
of tiny hamlets where he was, so far as is known, the first British
traveller.
As yet his record had been that of the enterprising mountain-
traveller; an interesting one, but not such as to warrant his later
fame. It was not until 1839 that he made the two journeys which
were to give him a genuine position in the mountain peerage.
One was the first complete circuit of Monte Viso; the other an
inspection of the Veneon Valley in the Dauphine Alps which
brought him to La Berarde, the first Englishman to reach the little
hamlet at the foot of the Ecrins which was later to develop into
the centre of Dauphine mountaineering. In both cases Forbes
wrote the first paragraph in a chapter of British mountaineering,the first dealing with attempts on the Viso that ended with
Mathews' ascent in 1861, the second with the exploration of the
Dauphin6 across which the names ofBonney, Moore, Whymper,Tuckett and Coolidge are written so clearly and so large.
It was during these two journeys that Forbes first began to
appreciate the mountains not only as an arena in which he mighttilt against the scientific unknowns, but also as a source of purelynon-scientific wonder. "The scenery is stupendous", he wrote in
an enthusiastic account ofthe Dauphine, and it was to La Berarde
that he returned in 1841.
This time there was no doubt about where his interests lay.
Forbes the scientist was still making his exact observations, but
Forbes the mountaineer, hiring Joseph Rodier, a guide whose
name is woven into the fabric ofDauphine exploration, was more
adventurous. First he crossed the glacier pass of the Col du Says
to Valgaudemar; then he returned by the Col du Sellar to
43
Vallouise, thus linking three main Dauphine valleys by hitherto
uncrossed passes.
Perhaps Forbes felt that he could conscientiously give time to a
little "pure" mountaineering in view of the arrangements which
he had made for scientific work later in the season. For the
previous year, at a meeting ofthe British Association in Glasgow,he had met Louis Agassiz, the great Swiss geologist whose
Etudes sur les Glaciers had concentrated a major part of scientific
thought on the problems presented by the Alps. Agassiz had
invited Forbes to his famous "Hotel des Neuchatelois" so that on
leaving the Dauphine in 1841 Forbes made his way to the Ober-
land, rested at the Grimsel Hospice, and then set out on a five-
hour tramp up the Unteraar glacier to Agassiz' encampment.The "Hotel des Neuchatelois" consisted ofa large cave on a rock-
island in the middle of the glacier, formed by a huge overhangingblock of mica schist, made more weatherproof by a wall of
stones, and more comfortable by layers of grass and oilcloth on
the rocky floor. It was this solitary spot that Agassiz, helped by
porters, guides, and scientific assistants, had turned into the centre
of his scientific expeditions of enquiry, and it was here that
Forbes spent three weeks during the summer of 1841, occasionally
travelling back to the Grimsel Hospice for a few days, but makingthe "hotel" the centre not only for scientific but also for moun-tain expeditions.
As in the Dauphine, he combined work and pleasure, his most
important expedition being an ascent of the Jungfrau, the fourth
that had taken place and the first British ascent a climb which
presented greater problems than the regular ascent of MontBlanc, an expedition which Forbes, for some inexplicable reason,
never attempted. Forbes enjoyed himself at the "Hotel des
Neuchatelois":
I here willingly record [he later wrote] that I shall never forgetthe charm of those savage scenes. The varying effects of sunshine,
cloud and storm upon the sky, the mountains and the glacier; the
rosy tints of sunset, the cold hues of moonlight, on a scene whichincluded no trace of animation and of which our party were the
sole spectators.
44
Here was a man ofwhom great things might have been expected;as it was, Forbes' concern with the great glacier controversy con-
tinued to limit the time he could devote to mountaineering; and,
finally, he was brought down by a series of illnesses from whichhe never recovered.
The Forbes of the mountaineering years has rarely been
described more accurately than by Ruskin, who met him at the
Hotel de la Poste on the Simplon in 1844. The meeting lingeredin Ruskin's memory, drove him to the championship of Forbes
in the argument which broke out later between Forbes and
Tyndall, and may even have influenced Ruskin's early attitude
to the mountains. Ruskin was looking through his sketches in
the coffee-room of the inn while his mother and wife were
demurely at work near by. Forbes, sitting in a corner of the
room, was quietly sketching. "Quiet, somewhat severe-lookingand pale", was how Ruskin described him. "Our busy fellow-
traveller seemed to us taciturn, slightly inaccessible, and even
Alpestre, and, as it were, hewn out of mountain flint, in his
serene labour", he added.
Forbes was interested in the sketches of so young a manRuskin was only twenty-five at the time. Ruskin suggested that
Forbes' sketch might be of the Matterhorn it was, in fact, ofthe
Weisshorn and all at once the scientist blazed into the moun-taineer as he replied. "No and when once you have seen the
Matterhorn, you will never take anything else for it."
Forbes had a feeling for mountains equalled only by his desire
to solve the great problems of the glaciers whose structure and
movement presented one of the main problems of the physicalworld into which scientists were enquiring. It was known that
glaciers moved, but it was not known how they moved. Were
they solid bodies which slid down the sides of the mountains as a
sledge will slide downhill? Were they viscous bodies which
flowed as water flows? Or did they, perhaps, move by a processof regelation, freezing, thawing and then re-freezing? It was to
the answers of such questions that Agassiz was seeking an answer
on the Unteraar glacier.
Throughout the next two decades scientific enquiry into these
45
problems led to a series of disputes conducted with a ferocity
which is slightly astonishing. Men felt strongly about the matter;
the disputes split old friendships, created bitterness, and developedinto a series ofalmost religious controversies. John Ball, who was
later to become the first President ofthe Alpine Club, recalls howone day at the Grimsel Hospice he overheard two young menwhohad travelled from America together, who had studied as friends
in Germany, and who were now parting company on the most
bitter terms of enmity. "I listened", he says, "and found that the
matter of dispute was neither of the common topics politics or
religion but the theory of the glaciers."
Forbes had realised, early on, that before one could solve manyof the glacier problems it was necessary to carry out detailed
measurements showing just how much glaciers moved, what
portions ofthem moved at the greatest speed, and at what speed,
and from the time of his stay at the "Hotel des Neuchatelois"
he devoted much of his time in the Alps to obtaining such
measurements.
He began this work in the summer of 1842, and it is of signifi-
cance in the story of mountaineering because it helped to raise
the status ofthe Alpine guides by bringing one of them, AugusteBalmat, into the world of scientific travellers as a companion and
friend rather than a hewer ofwood and drawer of water. Forbes
decided to make his measurements on the Mer de Glace above
Chamonix, and to help him he hired Balmat, a thoughtful self-
educated guide who had the objective enquiring mind of the
scientist. Together, the two men spent part of the early summerin driving metal stakes into various parts of the glacier, notingtheir positions, and finding how far they had moved after so
many hours or days. Often they were accompanied by another
guide, David Couttet of the Montanvert, and together theyformed an interesting trio; Forbes, carefully dressed in a suit of
soft chamois leather, long worsted stockings and a pair ofdouble-
soled London shoes which had been locally nailed, setting up his
instruments on the glacier; Balmat chipping observation marks
on the nearby rocks; and Couttet shielding Forbes' instrument
from the glare of the sun with a large green umbrella.
46
The observations proved three important things that the
glaciers moved steadily and not by fits and starts; that they moved
by night as well as by day; and that they moved faster in the
centre than at the sides. Theories had been formed on all three
points, but it needed Forbes, the hard-headed Scotsman, to get to
work on the glacier itself and prove the matter once and for all.
Satisfied with his results and having left Balmat to supervisefurther observations throughout the winter he was off again,this time with Professor Studer, the Swiss scientist, first to Arolla
and then to Evolena, in both ofwhich places he was probably the
first British traveller. He returned to Chamonix by way of
Zermatt, staying with the village doctor, for the little hamlet did
not have an inn, and then climbing the Riffelberg. It was here
that he made his famous drawing of the Matterhorn, almost a
geological sketch, which was later so praised by Ruskin in the
fourth volume ofModern Painters.
In the normal course of his scientific work, Forbes had alreadytravelled more above the snowline than any other Englishman.He was still in the mid-thirties. He appeared to be at the heightofhis power and on the verge ofa genuine mountaineering career.
Yet the following year, while travelling through Bonn on his
honeymoon, he was struck with fever from the effects of which
he never fully recovered. He continued his glacier observations,
though he relied more and more on Balmat. He made an enter-
prising attempt on the Aiguille du Moine with Balmat and
David Couttet. In 1851 he travelled to Norway, explored the
glaciers, and observed the total eclipse ofthe sun. Yet the crippling
effect of his illness prevented the development of his wanderingsinto anything approaching high climbing.
In spite of this, Forbes' influence continued to increase. In 1845
he had published his Travels through the Alps of Savoy, and for
years this was almost a text-book for mountain-travel. Eight
years later he published an account of his Norwegian visit and
appended to it a note of his wanderings in the Dauphine a note
which for more than a decade was virtually the only information
in English on the district, and throughout the fifties, Forbes kept
constantly in touch with the growing band of young men,
47
lawyers, doctors, and gentlemen of leisure, who were taking a
purely non-scientific interest in the Alps.
In 1853 he invited Balmat to visit him at his home in England,
and subsequently introduced him to Wills, thus being the god-father of that long association which culminated in Wills' famous
ascent ofthe Wetterhorn and ended with Balmat's death in Wills'
chalet, The Eagle's Nest, in the Valley of Sixt. He encouraged
Adams-Reilly in his great project of mapping Mont Blanc,
and played a significant part in having the map published by the
Alpine Club ofwhich he was, in 1859, made the first honorary
member.
Forbes died in 1868, worn out by illness and work, and rather
wondering, one may imagine, at the implications of the Matter-
horn disaster, whose sole English survivor, Edward Whymper,had explained to him in the Birmingham house where the
formation of the Alpine Club had first been formally discussed,
just how the dreadful accident had taken place.
Forbes never bowed to the new non-scientific reasons for
mountaineering which grew up during his later years. He never
developed into a mountaineer as did some of the later scientists
such as Tyndall and Bonney. Yet during the later period of his
life lie was, as was said of Coolidge, "the great master". He had,
after all, sensed the attraction of the great mountains before
Edward Whymper had been born. He had, moreover, dis-
covered by quiet observation how one could travel among them
in relative safety.
Neither Ruskin's revelation of the mountain glory nor Forbes'
careful enquiring journeys would have had much effect on the
Victorian public had it not been for the activities of a third man.
Both Ruskin and Forbes spoke to the informed, discerning, one-
thousandth ofthe population; few even among this small minorityhad any real knowledge of mountains and for the middle classes,
let alone for the vast belly-and-body masses, the Alps and their
names were not even symbols but queer words which meant little
more than unusual sounds used by men back from abroad.
48
Someone very different from either Forbes or Ruskin was
needed before any knowledge of mountains or mountaineeringcould, like rain on the earth, filter down deeply and yet more
deeply among Victoria's subjects so that eventually even the
most inarticulate had heard of at least one mountain.
Albert Smith, "the man ofMont Blanc", was cut for the job.He was different, harder, harsher, than either Ruskin or Forbes.
His early background was that of the small surgeon's practice
built up by his father in a sleepy Surrey town; his later experiencethat of a rather Bohemian playwright and author who was rarely
worried by such bourgeois matters as solvency.Smith's story is misleadingly simple. He was born in Chertsey
in 1816, received as a child a copy of The Peasants of Chamouni,
a book which described the accident to Dr. Hamel's party on
Mont Blanc, in 1820, and subsequently followed the news ofeach
new ascent of the mountain with an almost pathological interest.
The idea of climbing Mont Blanc obsessed him even though he
knew little or nothing about any other mountain in the Alps. Hestudied medicine in Paris, made a brave, hitch-hiking, roister-
doister journey to Chamonix where he volunteered, un-
successfully, as a porter willing to accompany any party setting
out for the summit and returned to London where the profession
of doctoring gradually left him and where he turned to writingas an alternative love.
As a contributor to Punch, an author of light plays, as dramatic
critic to the Illustrated London News and joint editor of a short-
lived magazine, The Man in the Moon, Smith trundled steadily upthe ladder in his new profession in a deft but slightly haphazard
way. In 1849 he visited the Middle East and returned to London
where in 1851 he gave his first public entertainment, "The Over-
land Mail".
The same year, Smith set out for Mont Blanc, a venture the
thought of which had nattered away at him for more than a
decade. Throughout the rough-and-tumble of authorship he had
retained much of the genuine mountain enthusiasm which had
driven him across France as a younger man with only a few
pounds in his pocket so that he might look at Mont Blanc and
49
chance his arm at climbing her. He had gone back to Chamonix
whenever the chance offered, spending a week or so with his
friends the Tairraz at the Hotel de Londres; kept from makingthe ascent ofMont Blanc, one feels, more by lack of finance than
by lack of courage.
Now, as a result of the success of "The Overland Mail" he had
money and leisure; both would be contributed to the ascent of
Mont Blanc. Smith was in almost every respect a totally different
sort of man from those who were about to create the sport of
mountaineering. It was not merely that he was different from,
and slightly disliked by, his contemporaries Douglas Jerrold
claimed that his initials represented merely two-thirds of the
truth, while Dickens resigned from the Garrick Club when
Smith was elected for in this he was comparable to many of the
most famous Victorian mountaineers, men of singular opinions,
stubborn will, and angry words. Smith was something more,
something that might have been considered quite inexcusable.
He was rather showy, and his profession, his enthusiasm, and his
ignorance brought him at times perilously near the edge of
vulgarity.
Sala's description of him paints a man who in most details was
a strange contrast to the future elders of the Alpine Club.
I can recall him [writes Sala] as a sturdy-looking, broad-shouldered,
short-necked man, with grey eyes, and flowing locks oflight brown,and large side-whiskers; later in life he wore a beard; and, on the
whole, he bore a most striking resemblance to Mr. Comyns Carr.
His voice was a high treble; his study was like a curiosity shop;
although the"curios'* were not highly remarkable from the stand-
point of high art, and were not very antique. Littered about the
room, which was on the ground floor, were piles of French novels,
in yellow paper covers, dolls, caricatures, toys of every conceivable
kind, a debardeuse silk shirt, crimson sash, and velvet trousers, the
white linen raiment of a Pierrot, cakes of soap from Vienna, madein the similitude of fruit, iron jewellery from Berlin of the historic
"Ich gab Goldfur Essen9
pattern, miniature Swiss chalets, porcelainand meerschaum pipes although Albert was no smoker and the
model of a French diligence.
50
He was also, adds Sala, one of die kindest and cheeriest of
mankind. He might have added that Smith was also one of
the most casual on his wedding-day he was found, at the hour
planned for the ceremony, quietly reading a paper at home, a
position from which he was dragged away by the officiating
clergyman.Yet there can be no doubt that Albert Smith, when he set out
for Mont Blanc, had a genuine enthusiasm for the adventure,
even though he knew that with any luck the ascent would provide
the material for some public performance. He set out in the right
spirit.
I found my old knapsack in a store-room [he writes], and I beat
out the moths and spiders, and filled it as of old, and on the first of
August, 1851, I left London Bridge in the mail-train of the South-
Eastern Railway, with my Lord Mayor and other distinguished
members of the corporation, who were going to the fetes at Paris
in honour of the Exhibition, and who, not having a knapsack under
their seat, lost all their luggage, as is no doubt chronicled in the
City archives.
At Chamonix he was joined by three men, Francis Philips, the
Hon. William Edward Sackville-West, and Charles G. Floyd,
all ofwhom were glad to join Mr. Smith in his ascent once they
learned his identity. The first two were to become, like Smith
himself, members of the Alpine Club solely on the strength of
their ascent ofMont Blanc.
After a day's waiting for good weather, the party set off, one
of the largest and most unwieldy parties ever to straggle out from
Chamonix. There was Smith and his three companions, a total
of sixteen guides, and about a score of porters and other volun-
teers who were accompanying the party varying distances up the
mountain.
The table of provisions provides an interesting comparison
with the contemporary ineal-in-a-biscuit school, and an in-
dication that the Victorians set about climbing much as
Wellington "first a full belly and then at 'em" set about
war.
Here are the provisions which added 456 francs, or roughly
, to the cost of Smith's expedition:
60 bottles of Vin Ordinaire
6 botdes of Bordeaux
10 botdes of St. George
15 bottles of St. Jean
3 botdes of Cognac1 bottle of Syrup of Raspberries
6 botdes of Lemonade
2 bottles of Champagne20 loaves
10 small cheeses
6 packets of chocolate
6 packets of sugar
4 packets of prunes
4 packets of raisins
2 packets of salt
4 wax candles
6 lemons
4 legs of mutton
4 shoulders of mutton
6 pieces of veal
i piece of beef
11 large fowls
3 5 small fowls
The ascent, made at a cost of nearly .60 for each of the
four travellers, was unremarkable. There was a bivouac on
the Grands Mulcts, a fine view from the summit, a safe descent,
and a triumphal entry into the village of Chamonix with
cannons firing, the whole population a-flutter with handker-
chiefs in the main street, and a festive table in the courtyardof the Hotel de Londres, dressed with bouquets and champagnebottles.
The ascent, the thirty-seventh of the mountain and the first to
be made by any future member of the Alpine Club, was not
without its critics, partly due to a particularly boisterous partyheld in Chamonix by Sir Robert Peel.
52
Saussure's observations and his reflections on Mont Blanc live in
his poetical philosophy [said the Daily News]. Those of Mr. Albert
Smith will be most appropriately accorded in a tissue of indifferent
puns and stale fast witticisms, with an incessant straining after smart-
ness. The aimless scramble of the four pedestrians to the top of
Mont Blanc, with the accompaniment of Sir Robert Peel's orgies
at the bottom, will not go far to redeem the somewhat equivocal
reputation of the herd of English tourists in Switzerland, for a
mindless and rather vulgar redundance of animal spirits.
Much the same criticism was to be levelled against both
Smith's description of the ascent, which forms the concluding
chapters ofhis The Story ofMont Blanc, and "The Ascent ofMont
Blanc'*, the entertainment which he subsequently produced at
the Egyptian Hall in Piccadilly. Both were a curious mixture of
gauche sensation, in which every incident was over-dramatised,
and a certain rather naive innocence. Both survived the criticisms.
"The Ascent of Mont Blanc", a display in which Smith
personally described a series ofdioramic views drawn by William
Beverley, and in which the whole journey from London to the
summit of Mont Blanc was interlarded with historical, topo-
graphical, and various less serious allusions, opened on March 15,
1852. Even after the first performance, Smith appears to have
been uncertain as to its financial success. He need not have
worried.
"Mount Blanc" ran until two years before Smith's death in
1860. Only three months after its first performance, the Prince
Consort, the Prince of "Wales the future Edward VII and
Prince Alfred, attended a special private morning performance of
the show. Two years later a special performance was given before
the Queen and the Prince Consort at Osborne, Smith afterwards
being presented with a diamond scarf-pin by the Queen; and, yet
another two years afterwards, a third Command performancewas given, this time at "Windsor before the Court and King
Leopold I of Belgium. The show, for such it was, played to
packed houses, making Smith not only financially but in reputa-
tion, so that for a whole segment of the population he became
"the man ofMont Blanc".
53
"The Game ofMont Blanc", complete with rules and counters,
and approximating roughly to an Alpine snakes-and-ladders, was
sold by the thousand while the music which drummed throughthe mid-i8so's included, as a direct result of Albert Smith's
efforts, the "Mont Blanc Quadrille" and the "Chamonix Polka".
St. Bernard dogs were brought to London by Francois Favret, one
of Smith's guides, and one ofthe animals presented to the Queen.Swiss misses, Swiss costumes, and all the attributes of a carefully
planned advertising campaign jollied up enthusiasm while Smith
was filling the Egyptian Hall. Throughout it all he returned to
Chamonix almost every year, being feted not only as a goodfellow but also as a public benefactor. In 1853 he was invited to
the ceremonial opening ofthe first hut on Mont Blanc; four years
later he was invited to the village so that he might conduct the
Prince of Wales, then making his first visit to Switzerland, on a
tour of the Glacier des Bossons. Almost everything that he did
had some publicity value for the show which is claimed to have
brought him .30,000, and which certainly accounted for most
of the ji8,ooo which he left when he died.
There can, from the safe, secure, educated viewpoint of the
Victorian mountaineers, have been few things more likely to
bring Alpine climbing into disrepute than Albert Smith and his
rather ostentatious showmanship. Yet in spite of it Albert Smith
received, and accepted, an invitation to become an original
member of the Alpine Club revealing in his reply, incidentally,
that he and John Auldjo, who had climbed Mont Blanc in 1827,
had once contemplated forming an Alpine club. Even such a
grim, behind-the-stockades figure as Douglas Freshfield, whosaw Smith's show at the age of nine, admired the man of MontBlanc and later wrote ofhim that:
He came forwardjust at the psychological moment when railwaysacross France had brought the Alps within the Englishman's longvacation. And, strange to say, he had a genuine passion for MontBlanc, which fortune or rather his own enthusiasm enabled him to
put to profit.
Whatever failings Smith may have had, he did two things. He
54
encouraged men to visit Chamonix, and not a few of those whodid so took the next step and climbed Mont Blanc. Secondly, and
more important, Smith revealed to scores of young men that
there existed a field for adventure which they had never before
suspected. Most of his audience naturally consisted of men and
women who would never visit the Alps, let alone climb them.
Yet among the crowd there was more than one youngster wholooked, through the slightly distorting eyes of Smith as through
magic casements. On nearer acquaintance he might revise his
opinions ofwhat he saw. The mountains might appear to him in
a light rather different from that ofthe gas-lit Egyptian Hall with
its girls in national costume, its fancy programmes, and its
Barnum-and-Bailey atmosphere. Yet without Albert Smith he
would never have felt like "that watcher of the skies when a new
planet swims into his ken". His eagle eyes would never have dis-
cerned that new world waiting to be conquered which lay beyondthe bluster and rumbustious exaggerations of Albert Smith.
Smith helped to convert many young men to mountaineeringand for this he was forgiven much. Yet there is another reason
for the influence which he exercised over the most unexpected of
the Victorians. This is his sincerity. He really loved the Alps, and
the more discerning among his audiences sensed, even ifthey did
not know, that he had not gone to Chamonix entirely with the
idea of making money.It is a little too easy to laugh at Smith's sensational descriptions.
It is difficult to agree that, as he says of the Mur de la Cote:
"Should the footslip,
or the baton give way, there is no chance
for life you would glide like lightning from one frozen crag to
another and finally be dashed to pieces, hundreds and hundreds
of feet below in the horrible depths of the glacier." Yet even a
few years later Alfred "Wills, that sober, experienced and careful
climber who was to become President of the Alpine Club, could
say, of the summit of the Wetterhorn: "I was almost appalled byour position." Neither words nor situation are exactly com-
parable, but it is possible to believe that Smith was merely
putting into the language of his public much the same thoughts
that fluttered at times across the minds ofmany early climbers as
55
they pioneered their ways up what was later to become "an easy
day for a lady3
'.
Yet the real reason for Albert Smith's extravagant terms, so out
of keeping both with the other mountain language of the time
and with what he appears genuinely to have felt, was a rather
different one.
Smith saw the mountains, epitomised by Mont Blanc, not
clearly as Forbes had seen them, not with the eyes of genius
through which Ruskin had looked at them, but through a lumi-
nous golden haze ofunreality. His writing was in oneway queerly
comparable with that of the modern rock-climbing writers who
go to the other extreme with carefully stressed understatement.
Both reject the idea that the common mass can stand, as it were,
on "the edge of all things". For Albert Smith, Mont Blanc was
the Promised Land. Round it he built his own imaginative
fortifications, making it not only for him but for all those who
might crowd into his display, a distant, virtually inaccessible place,
a sanctuary about which one might inform the crowd but about
which it would be unwise to let slip too much factual informa-
tion.
In spite of the cannons of Chamonix, in spite of Ruskin's
disgust, the man ofMont Blanc was much nearer in spirit both to
Forbes and to the "Don Quixote ofDenmark Hill", than any of
the three ever imagined. All would have been gravely offended
by the idea that Mont Blanc could be ascended without guidesas it was by Kennedy's party in 1855. All would have ridiculed
the idea that it could ever be climbed alone, as it was by Frederick
Morshead in 1864.
All had to make their own individual contributions before
there was much hope of mountain-climbing developing into a
serious and significant method of employing one's time.
Chapter Two
PIONEERS, O PIONEERSAnd greatness is the vision, not the deed.
Greatness is to be one with the vision, and ensue it,
Greatness is suffering, greatness a long need,
And distant bugles cryingfaintly through it,
"Lights out! Lights out!"
Greatness is to hear the bugles and not to doubt.
HUMBERT
mountain world whose existence was revealed in the
JL forties and fifties was investigated by men who were
explorers rather than mountaineers. They were mainly interested
in treading into those places of which men had no knowledge;
only by chance did the one area for their discoveries remaining in
Europe lie above the snowline. These explorers had a virgininnocence of the first principles of mountaineering; they let their
ropes be held by guides, they knew nothing of breaking strains,
and they built up their principles of snow-craft almost as theywent along, largely by trial and error. Only later, as the Golden
Age continued during the later 1850*8, did the glories of the
mountain world, as such, usurp the prime glory of discovery;
only then, as a result of mutual intercourse and the exchange of
experience, did the happy few develop the craft of mountaineer-
ing.
It is not easy to understand the lustre ofthe unknown that hungabout the Alps little more than a hundred years ago.
When Queen Victoria came to the throne, the summit of
Mont Blanc had been reached, as a most exceptional effort, onlyhalf a century previously and only some thirty men, other than
the guides, had stood upon its summit since that memorable
event. The Jungfrau and the Finsteraarhorn had, it is true, been
climbed by those redoubtable Swiss brothers, the Meyers. Two
57
of the lower peaks of Monte Rosa had been climbed, althoughthe summit had so far escaped the conquerors. There were a
number of passes across the Alps, as there had been for hundreds
of years, but in between there lay a country, running from the
Mediterranean to the peaks of Austria, which was as little known
to most Englishmen as far Cathay. For the Victorian moun-
taineers, the Alps, only recently depopulated of dragons yet
lying in a great crescent only some 400 miles from their com-
fortable firesides, had much the same significance as the thin blue
haze of outer space has for the adventurers of today.
Toward the western end of this crescent lay Mont Blanc, the
most famous as well as the highest mountain in the Alps. Near
its foot lay Chamonix, later to become the centre for ascents not
only ofMont Blanc but ofa whole galaxy offine peaks around it
such as the Aiguille Verte, Mont Mallet, and Mont Dolent. Tothe east lay the Pennine Alps with Monte Rosa, one of the few
mountains in the range whose ascent had been frequently
attempted, and whose lower summits had been reached. Near by
lay such peaks as the Weisshorn, the Dent Blanche, the Grand
Combin, the Matterhorn, and a score ofminor summits, many of
them easily accessible from the little hamlet of Zermatt.
To the north and north-east, across the deep trough of the
Rhone Valley, lay the Bernese Oberland with the great peaks of
the Jungfrau, Monch, and Eiger so plainly visible from the
northern plain of Switzerland; with the Wetterhorn, rising almost
from the outskirts of the village of Grindelwald; and, deeper in
the group, among a tangle of glaciers that were the longest in the
whole of the Alps, such mountains as the Schreckhorn and the
Finsteraarhorn. Farther east stretched the Lepontine and the
Bernina Alps as well as the Dolomites and numerous smaller and
lower groups.In the far south-west, beyond the Graian Alps, lay the Dauphine
with its unknown and unmapped peaks south of die Romanche,an area into which no Englishman had yet penetrated.The conquest of this whole range, first of those peaks in the
more central groups such as the Pennines and the range ofMontBlanc, later of those in the groups to the east and the west, went
58
Irt
u
cu
through a number of phases, the most important of which was
the Golden Age which started with the conquest of the Wetter-
horn by Alfred Wills in 1854 and ended with the ascent of the
Matterhorn by Whymper and his party in 1865, by which time
the Meije, in the Dauphine, was the only great peak in the Alpswhich had not been climbed. The Silver Age followed, lasting
until the turn of the century and being marked by the develop-ment of guideless climbing, by the climbing of old mountains bynew routes, by climbing in ranges beyond the Alps, by the
development of climbing in Britain, and by the increase of
mountaineering among women.
Wills' ascent of the Wetterhorn in 1854 is generally taken as
marking the start of "sporting" climbing. It was not the first
ascent of the mountain, whose early history is still being un-
ravelled by scholars, but it was the one which became best knownboth through the story which Wills told to his fellow-climbers
when he returned to London, and the description of the ascent
which he later gave in the Wanderings. The Wetterhorn's position
in the forefront of the view from Grindelwald, a village already
being visited by hundreds of travellers each year, helped to make
this ascent by a travelling Englishman on his honeymoon the one
event which in the eyes ofmany people marked the creation of a
new sport.
During the following few years, men went out to the Alpsfrom Britain in increasing numbers. In 1855 the highest peak of
Monte Rosa was reached without guides by the Rev. Charles
Hudson, the finest amateur of his day, and a party of young
Cambridge men. The Dom in the Eastern Pennines fell in 1858
to the Rev. Ll. Davies, and the Eiger to Charles Carrington.
Among the other great peaks ofthe Alps, the Rimpfischhorn, the
Aletschhorn, and the Bietschhorn fell to British climbers in the
following year and so, in 1860, did the Grand Paradis, the Grande
Casse, and the Alphubel.
By the turn of the sixties, the stream of activity was in full
flood, and by 1865 more than a score ofthe major Alpine summits
which had defied the native Swiss were beaten into submission bythe carefully swung axes of British climbers and their guides.
V.M. 4 6l
The Dauphine, that queer, lovely country south of the main
Alpine chain, hung out longest after the Matterhorn tragedy of
1865, and it was not until 1877 that the first chapter of Alpine
conquest was definitively closed with the ascent of the Meije by a
remarkable Frenchman, Boileau de Castelnau.
Throughout the whole of the period which began with the
exploration of the 1840'$ and has continued until the present day,
there has been what a Government department might call a
progression of amenities throughout the Alps.
Four things, above all, differentiated the Alps of that distant
era from the Alps of today. First, the men who stepped up on to
them stepped into the unknown. Secondly, there was a completeabsence of Alpine huts. Thirdly, there was the lack of what
modern climbers would consider even the most elementary
weight-saving equipment. Fourthly, there was the ameliorating
cheapness of guides and porters.
The first of these factors was by far the most important.
There seemed [said Whymper of the Matterhorn in 1860] to be
a cordon drawn around it, up to which one might go, but no farther.
Within that invisible line gins and effireets were supposed to exist
the WanderingJew and the spirits ofthe damned. The superstitious
natives in the surrounding valleys (many ofwhom firmly believed
it to be not only the highest mountain in the Alps, but in the world)
spoke of a ruined city on its summit wherein the spirits dwelt; and
if you laughed, they gravely shook their heads; told you to look
yourself to see the castles and the walls, and warned one against
rash approach, lest the infuriated demons from their impregnable
heights might hurl down vengeance for one's derision.
Although this was, of course, merely the opinion of one man
upon the reaction of his guides to one mountain, it was a typical
reaction even in 1860; it was even more typical a decade earlier.
"The cordon up to which one might go" was a real thing
psychologically for many of the Victorian mountaineers, and a
very real and far more substantial one for the Swiss guides whotravelled with them and gave them the benefit of their long
experience with the mountains.
62
The lack of huts would probably be even more disconcerting
for the mass of Alpine travellers. The^/te beneath the stars, or at
best beneath an overhanging rock, was the rule for the pioneers
rather than the exception. There were, of course, innumerable
porters on demand to carry blankets; there were guides at relatively
cheap rates who could reconnoitre the most suitable spots for the
overnight bivouac; there still remained the open air, the un-
certainty of the morrow, the awaited step into what was at best
the little known. Ofmodern weight-saving equipment such as
wind-proof clothing, condensed foods, and nylon rope, the
pioneers had none. Their ladders, which they occasionally
carried in order to cross the more difficult spots on a glacier, were
of heavy wood; their clothes were very largely those of the
British countryside, heavily manufactured articles only slightly
adapted to the needs of the Alps. Their boots were, in manycases, merely stout walking shoes locally hobbed.
It is doubtful if the fourth factor, the cheapness ofman-power,the fact that porters were available to carry the straw or the
shawls, to pack the fuel for the fire and to carry the relative
luxuries, ever made up against contemporary standards for the
fact that it was customary to sleep in the open or in the roughest
of bivouacs. It is doubtful if all the porters made up for the
clothes that were unsuitably designed for high altitudes or for the
lack of boots, breeches, ropes, or ice-axes specifically designed for
the job. The climbers of the 1850*8 and die i86o's were in fact
of a toughness that is rather astonishing. It has been said that no
one other than the Victorians could have withstood the cold and
harshness of certain Royal homes; it is equally true that manymodern climbers would hardly be willing to follow in the steps
ofthe mountain pioneers with only the equipment that was used
by them.
Mountaineering, in those early days, required little equipmentand an equally small amount of expert knowledge. One result
of this happy set of circumstances was that during the early years
of the Golden Age the Alps abounded in young University men
whose means allowed them to spend a pleasant holiday in the
centres lying in a great half-moon around the Alps, and to sally
63
out, as and when they wished, into voyages of exploration. It
also allowed, perhaps rather surprisingly, the male members of a
large number of young married couples who spent their honey-moons on the Continent, to combine fidelity with an occasional
rumbustious Alpine excursion. Wills, Hudson, Kennedy, and
Frederick Morshead are only some of those climbers whoinsisted on spending their honeymoons in the Alps. Leslie
Stephen's Regrets of a Mountaineer are well known.
The cost of climbing, in its early days, was not large. The one
exception was the ascent of Mont Blanc which held its price of
about .30 per person until Hudson and his party broke the
guides' monopoly with their guideless ascent from St. Gervais
in 1855. Yet in 1862 the young John Stogdon, who hired a good
guide, who travelled throughout the Oberland for ten days and
who must have been abroad for almost double that time, records
that he had only 19 for his holiday. As late as 1880 Frederick
Gardiner, that steady and conscientious climber from Liverpool
whose record ofascents almost equals in number that of Coolidgea man, moreover, who by no means stinted himself in the
benefits of life talked of .50 for his general expenses, and of
.25 for guides, for a six-week season.
It was only rarely that one came upon such a man as the inn-
keeper below a previously uncrossed pass who replied, when
objections to his bill were raised, that "he had carefully reflected
upon the matter, and had come to the conclusion that no one
would ever come in any case, and that, therefore, he had better
charge when he had the opportunity".The relative cheapness with which one could go climbing, the
relative ease ofaccess ofthe Alps, and the lack ofspecialised know-
ledge which it was thought necessary to have, meant that a whole
host of people were drawn up into the mountains who in spite
of their genuine interest finally remained only on the fringe of
mountaineering.
Following Ruskin, there were the artists such as GeorgeBarnard, who in 1841 carried out a long Alpine tour with his
brother-in-law, Michael Faraday, and their respective wives, and
who later became drawing-master at Rugby. Barnard, as his
64
books on drawing prove, had a genuine feeling for mountains,
and he was one ofthe first men to get high among them so that he
might draw them accurately. Yet his interest was not that of the
mountaineer. He speaks of "the awful solitude of the Alps", and
admits:"Although I have for many years found my greatest
pleasure in studying amongst the Alps, I have only climbed
sufficiently high to obtain the views I wished to paint, finding
that if time and strength were spent in climbing there was little
left for careful drawing." It is a measure ofthe Victorians that he
should add: "It is not surprising that, after a long day's walk of
thirty or forty miles, the sketch then made should be hasty, or
thrust aside at the welcome sound of the dinner-bell."
There were many such as Barnard, more courageous than
Ruskin, inheriting the knowledge of the previous ten years,
helping to prepare the way for the men to whom the business of
climbing was the main thing that mattered.
There were many such as Oscar Browning, the queer Eton
master, sacked through a dispute in which he expressed his own
point of view at the cost of all things, a man with a perceptive
yet dilettante approach to the mountains.
My chief motive for Alpine travel was health [he admitted] and
as to its beneficial results in that respect there can be no doubt. I
could not have got through my work at Eton without it.
His attitude was almost that of the Philistine, and probably,
too, typical of that outer penumbra of young men who were
attracted only superficially to the mountains. "I have always
maintained that the three most exciting emotions I have ever
experienced have been fox-hunting, mountaineering, and stand-
ing for Parliament", he wrote later, "and I do not know which
is the most exciting of the three." Browning, in many ways
representative of those who were tested by mountaineering in
early life and found wanting, revealed himselfwhen he admitted
that: "One became tired of living upon a knapsack, and never
being absolutely clean, of seldom sleeping in a decent room or
enjoying wholesome food, and when September arrived I beganto long for the fleshpots of civilisation."
V.M. 4* 65
Some men were of sterner stuff. The lack ofwholesome food,
the lack of the decent room that so often meant the fleas of the
persistent Alpine joke, the frugality, the hardship and the
occasional danger all these were the inescapable necessities for a
handful of young men, many of them University students, who
during the 1850'$ travelled through the Alps and employed Swiss
guides to take them up a whole host of hitherto unclimbed
summits. Their climbing was carried out in a hearty, not to say
boisterous, manner. Substantial food and drink formed part of
the adventure; there was a casualness about the danger, and good
living was mixed with surprise that the mountains could, and did,
suddenly play tricks on those who were climbing them.
Few passages ofAlpine literature summon up these qualities of
the early days better than one in a paper which Thomas Hinch-
liff contributed to Peaks, Passes and Glaciers, that anthology of
mountain experiences which was to precede the Alpine Journal.
The provision knapsacks were emptied and used as seats [says
Hinchliffj; bottles of red wine were stuck upright in the snow; a
goodly leg of cold mutton on its sheet of paper formed the centre,
garnished with hard eggs and bread and cheese, round which we
ranged ourselves in a circle. High festival was held under the deepblue heavens, and now and then, as we looked up at the wonderful
wall of rocks which we had descended, we congratulated ourselves
on the victory. M. Seller's oranges supplied the rare luxury of a
dessert, and we were just in the full enjoyment of the delicacy whena booming sound, like the discharge of a gun far away over our
heads, made us all at once glance upwards to the top ofthe Trifthorn.
Close to the craggy summit hung a cloud of dust, like dirty smoke,and in a few seconds another and larger one burst forth several
hundred feet lower. A glance through the telescope showed that a
fall of rocks had commenced, and the fragments were leaping downfrom ledge to ledge in a series of cascades. The uproar became
tremendous; thousands of fragments making every variety of noise
according to their size, and producing the effect ofa fire ofmusketryand artillery combined, thundered downwards from so great a heightthat we waited anxiously for some considerable time to see themreach the snowfield below. As nearly as we could estimate the
distance, we were 500 yards from the base of the rocks, so we
66
thought that, come what might, we were in a tolerably secure
position. At last we saw many of the blocks plunge into the snowafter taking their last fearful leap; presently much larger fragments
followed; the noise grew fiercer and fiercer, and huge blocks beganto fall so near to us that we jumped to our feet, preparing to dodgethem to the best of our ability. "Look out", cried someone, and
we opened out right and left at the approach of a monster, evidently
weighing many hundredweights, which was coming right at us
like a huge shell fired from a mortar. It fell with a heavy thud not
more than 20 feet from us, scattering lumps of snow into the circle.
The incident was experienced, one feels, more with interest than
with fear; almost with a belief that such things were inevitable
when one ventured into the unknown regions of the Alps.
Hinchliff himself, a barrister whose wealth obviated the need
for practising, was typical of the early mountain-travellers on
whose explorations the Alpine Club which held many of its
early meetings in his chambers was founded. He was leisurely,
outspoken, and independent: he described himself as the poacherof Mont Blanc, for when he made the climb in 1857 he refused
to employ the stipulated minirnurri of eight guides but success-
fully made the ascent with half the number. He made few
spectacular expeditions, although he climbed both the Altels and
Monte Rosa twice, made the first ascent of Mont Blanc by the
Ancien Passage since the accident to Dr. HaxneTs party in 1820,
climbed the Finsteraarhorn, and made a large number of minor
excursions. He wandered rather than climbed, but he knewas Ruskin did not that beneath the light shed by danger and
difficulty the climber might see a world very different from that
presented to the less adventurous traveller. The real lover of the
mountains, he stressed more than once, "finds in his most difficult
excursions, not merely an exciting and adventurous sport but
the enjoyment of a new sensation that of being brought into
immediate contact with the brilliant wonders of an unknown
world".
HinchlifF first visited the Alps in 1854, at the age of twenty-
nine, and only eight years later was disabled in a shooting
accident which forced him to divert his activities to less strenuous
67
travel. His influence on the development of climbing was due
to his "clubbability", the extent of his interest in all things per-
taining to mountains, and the publication, in 1856, of his Summer
Months among the Alps, a book which together with Wills'
Wanderings among the High Alps, had a decisive effect.
Alfred Wills, son of a J.P., a financially well-set-up fellow,
coming to maturity in the expansive years that preceded the
Great Exhibition, was in many ways the laboratory specimen of
the early Victorian mountaineer. Barrister, Judge in die Queen's
Bench Division he was the man who tried Oscar Wilde he is
of importance in the Victorian mountain hierarchy for three
separate reasons.
He was, first, the prototype ofthose gentlemen whose ordinary
mountain wanderings developed into genuine mountain-climb-
ing. His experience came slowly, and he travelled in the Alpsfor many years without attempting a major peak. Throughoutthe whole of his life, difficult mountaineering was merely one of
the attractions which he found in the Alps. He took his wife to
Switzerland for her honeymoon so that she might, as he said, be
shown some of the glories of the glaciers. And it was on his
honeymoon that he accomplished, almost accidentally it might
seem, his famous ascent ofthe Wetterhorn.
Wills was, secondly, one of the first of the Alpine pioneers to
forge the relationship between guides and their employers that
was one of the great features of the Golden Age. He dedicated
his Wanderings to Balmat, "my guide and friend, my tried and
faithful companion in many difficulties and some dangers". Andin much of his subsequent writing he dropped the word "guide"and referred to Balmat solely as friend. It was only to Balmat
that he would entrust his wife on her mountain-wanderings while
he, Wills, made some more ambitious excursion. And it was
Balmat who helped in the purchase of the plot of land in the
Valley of Sixt where Wills built The Eagle's Nest for the wife
who was to die before she crossed the threshold. In all this there
is ample evidence that Wills, more than most men, had such
confidence in Balmat that he helped to create, in the guides, what
Lord Schuster has called "a new race of men'*.
68
Thirdly, there was the ascent of the Wetterhom, and the storyof that ascent which Wills gave to the world in the Wanderings.The ascent was by no means the first of the mountain; nor ofthat
particular peak of the Wetterhom; nor even of that particular
peak from that particular side. It was, however, the first that was
to gain any measure of notice outside the small select group of
Alpine devotees. That fact, combined with the spectacular and
engaging form of the peak, its proximity to Grindelwald, a
village from which the mountain was so readily visible, and the
exciting duel played out on the mountain between Wills* partyand the two local Grindelwald men who finally made the ascent
with him, combined to give a certain importance to the ascent
which has turned the date of 1854 into that when "sporting"
mountaineering is popularly supposed to have begun.Wills first visited the Alps at the age of eighteen, while still a
student at London University, and during it made merelya single visit to the Jardin. Four years later he went back,
crossing a number ofminor passes, visiting Zermatt and making,from Interlaken, the first recorded ascent of the SchynigePlatte.
In 1852 he went out again, spending nine weeks abroad and
making a number of pleasant if unspectacular excursions the
crossings of the Tschingel, Monte Moro, Allalin, and Theodule
Passes and visiting Chamonix for the first time. From die
mountaineering point ofview it was hardly an important season,
but one record that Wills has left casts an interesting light on the
costs of the day.
We were out nine weeks [he later wrote], one week of which
was passed in Paris, where the expenditure was, of course, muchabove average. We spent no small sum in guides and carriages,
and although economical stinted ourselves in nothing. The trip
cost us less than ^40 each, everything included.
It was in 1853 that Wills first appears to have embarked with
full vigour on an Alpine career. Early in the year Forbes had
invited Balmat to visit him at his home at Clifton, and Wills had
been invited to meet the couple in London.
I was [says Wills] greatly struck by the absence of false modestyor bashful timidity from his bearing. And, although he mightsometimes be guilty of a conventional solecism, in all graver respects
he was sure to speak and act like a gentleman.
The details of "Wills' meeting with Balmat in the Alps later in
the same year form an interesting commentary on the Trade
Union atmosphere which then permeated the guides' com-
munity at Chamonix, ham-stringing initiative wherever possible,
putting a premium on mediocrity, and doing much to channel
every line of endeavour up the one "routine" peak of MontBlanc. The crux of the system was the rota, on which every
registered guide the only ones allowed legally to work was
duly entered. Many of the men, possibly the majority of them,
were mere glacier guides, "worthy to carry a lady's shawl on the
glacier", yet incapable ofnew or major expeditions. Many were
illiterate; only a few, ofwhich Balmat was one, had fought their
way up until they had more than a passable knowledge of
practical science and were invaluable to such scientists as Forbes.
Yet under the rota system such men as Balmat were lumped
together on the list with the near-incompetents. And, a subject
continually contested by the Alpine Club, any climber comingto Chamonix was forced to take the man at the head of the rota,
however useless he might be for the project in hand.
It was in vain that you expostulated you had an old friend on the
list you did not like the look ofthe guide thus fortuitously presented
another had been recommended to you this had nothing to do
with the matter [protested Wills]. Superior skill, energy and
competency brought no advantage to the good guide; impertinenceand incapacity were no disqualification to the bad guide.
So pernicious was the system that one English mountaineer left
a substantial cheque for the sufferers from a disastrous fire at
Chamonix on the condition that it should remain untouched
until an English traveller was allowed to choose his own guideand to determine for himselfjust how many men he should take
on any particular expedition.
It was unlikely, however, that the wit of the Victorians would
70
be unable to find some way of evading such scandalous regula-
tions. One such method was discovered by Wills or, quite
possibly, recommended to him by Forbes. If a guide were hired
beyond the jurisdiction ofthe Chamonix Commune and broughtto Chamonix by way of a col (those being the operative words)then the traveller who arrived with him was allowed to keep his
companion, whatever might be the latter's place on the rota.
Wills had therefore arranged to meet Balmat at Sallanches and
to reach Chamonix by the Col de Voza, a ruse which enabled
him to keep the guide for a season which was, as it turned out,
cut short by bad weather.
The following year he was back on his honeymoon, made a
number of minor ascents, spent a night with his wife on the Merde Glace so that she might see the beauties of the place, took her
up the Torrenthorn, and then decided that before he returned to
London he would make the ascent of one major peak.
I had crossed many a lofty col, and wound my way among manya labyrinth of profound and yawning crevasses [he wrote later].
I had slept on the moraine of a glacier, and on the rugged mountain-
side, but I had never yet scaled any ofthose snowy peaks which rise
in tempting grandeur above the crests of cols and the summits of
the loftier passes.
His choice fell on the Jungfrau, and Balmat suggested that they
should consult a local guide. This was Ukich Lauener, the "tall,
straight, active, knowing-looking fellow, with a cock's feather
stuck jauntily in his high-crowned hat", a guide who quickly
explained that owing to the lateness of the season the Jungfraucould only be tackled from the far side of the Oberland, an
expedition for which Wills had not the time. The Finsteraarhorn
and the Schreckhorn were both rejected for similar reasons, and
only then did Wills suggest the Wetterhorn.
Lauener suggested, presumably with his tongue in his cheek,
that the matter was possible and that the Herr might, in any case,
like to make a first ascent. Wills rose to the bait, travelled up the
valley to Grindelwald with his wife and, a few days later, set out
for the Wetterhorn.
71
With him there were: Balmat; Auguste Simond, a Chamonix
guide whom Balmat knew and who had happened to be in Inter-
laken a guide who had once held a fully grown man off the
ground at armVlength and who was soon nicknamed "Sam-
son"; Ulrich Lauener, who was in charge of the party; and Peter
Bohren, another Grindelwald man who had been to the plateau
from which the three Wetterhorn peaks all spring, at least three
times that season.
On the mountain, after a rough bivouac, the party found itself
being outflanked by two mysterious figures, one ofwhom carried
a fir-tree on his shoulder, a tree comparable to the "flag" carried
by Lauener which was in fact a great sheet of iron attached to a
12-ft. mast. After a great shouting-match carried out across the
snows, it was learned that the two men were local chamois-
hunters, Christian Aimer and his brother-in-law Ulrich Kauf-
mann, both ofwhom were to win fame as guides. Hearing of the
attempt by Wills' party, they had decided to climb the peak for
the honour of their native valley, had brought the fir-tree to place
on the summit beside the iron "flag", and had climbed the lower
crags during the night. Eventually, both partiesjoined forces and
reached the summit together.
As they went higher on the mountain, the mood of the partyaltered. "One must never shout on the great peaks," Balmat
warned Wills, "one never knows what will happen." The local
Grindelwald men might be less impressed, but both for the
Chamoniard and for Wills there was a new wonder as they trod
through the summit ridge and saw "a few yards of glittering ice
at our feet, and then, nothing between us and the green slopes of
Grindelwald, nine thousand feet beneath".
Wills' reactions at that moment, when he broke through not a
physical but a mental barrier raised by the unknown, providea clue to the whole inner driving force of Victorian mountain-
eering.
We felt [he wrote later] as in the more immediate presence of
Him who had reared this tremendous pinnacle, and beneath the
"majestical roof" of whose deep blue Heaven we stood, poised, as
it seemed, half-Way between the earth and the sky.
72
He was there, he knew, on sufferance. He had a great humility.
Mountaineering, he might have said had he lived a hundred years
later, had added to both his intellectual and his emotional stature.
At first glance, there was a whole multiplicity of contradictoryreasons for the climbing carried out by the young men of Wills'
time. Some climbed because they desired to explore, and the
Alps formed the most convenient field for their exploration.
Some climbed "for the exercise". Some climbed for a sight ofthe
majestic scenery which could not be viewed, as Ruskin had im-
agined, from the bottom of the mountains. Yet the commondenominator, which could be seen more clearly as the century
progressed, lay outside the realm of material experience. It lay,
rather, in the realm of the inner spirit, enclosed in a dissatisfaction
with the great material progress ofthe age, a dissatisfaction which
it was rarely possible and even more rarely expedient to express.
This is shown in the composition ofone group ofmen, four or
five ofwhom were associated in a whole list ofimportant climb-
ing expeditions during the 1 850*5. There were the three Smythbrothers, Charles Ainslie, Charles Hudson, and E. S. Kennedy,and it is significant that three of them two of the Smyths, and
Hudson were clergymen, while Kennedy, who wrote Thoughtson Being at the age of thirty-three and who was renowned for his
persistent question, "Is it right?", seriously contemplated taking
Holy Orders. They were all "serious" young men; they all gaveconsiderable thought to the problems which the growing know-
ledge of science was creating; and they all appear to have found in
their climbing some solace from the troubles of the world that
was something more important than mere escapism.
Hudson was the finest mountaineer, not only of the whole
group but of the whole generation, the man who was "almost
as great as a guide", and who was even more largely responsible
for the conquest ofthe Matterhorn than was Whymper. He spent
the winter of 1852-1853 in Switzerland he was then twenty-four and reconnoitred a new route up Mont Blanc, returned to
England where he was ordained, and then went to the Crimea
where he served as Chaplain with the Forces and, after the fall of
Sebastopol, went for an adventurous trip across Armenia and
73
approached Mount Ararat. Returning to the Alps in 1855 he
made, with the Smyths and John Birkbeck, the first ascent of the
highest point of Monte Rosa, an expedition in which the guides
followed the amateurs. A week later, he made the first guideless
ascent of Mont Blanc, an event which the guides did everything
in their power to prevent. He continued to climb almost every
year until his marriage in 1862 contriving, indeed, to visit
Zermatt during his honeymoon and returned to the Alps in
1865 when he introduced the young Douglas Hadow to the Alps
and, a few days later, was killed with him on the Matterhorn
after having made the first ascent of the mountain with Lord
Francis Douglas and Michael Croz (both ofwhom also perished),
Whymper, and the two Taugwalders.
Hudson, being more competent than any of his contempo-
raries, found it necessary to remove, from between the mountain
and himself, as it were, the third party which consisted of the
guide. The acclaim which greeted the ascent by Kennedy and
himselfofMont Blanc was only partially due to the fact that such
guideless climbing lifted a large financial weight from the
shoulders ofyouthful Alpinists. It gave also a sense of satisfaction
totally different from that gained from any climb in which
guides took part.
In some cases the guides trod carefully in the rear, but even then
their inborn experience of the weather, ofjust what risks could
be taken with any particular set of circumstances, was alwaysavailable in reserve. With guideless climbing, the amateurs were
forced to stand four-square by their own judgements. Once theyhad reached the ability of a Hudson it was only thus that theycould fairly face the facts of mountaineering life.
It was not until later that guideless climbing fell into disrepute,
largely due to the antics of the Rev. Girdlestone who appears to
have been protected from disaster only by exceptional luck and
who published in 1870 the story of his travels in The High Alpswithout Guides, a book that created considerable controversy and
which, in the opinion of many, did the cause of climbing a
serious disservice.
The Matterhorn itself was first climbed without guides in
74
1876 by Gust, Cawood, and Colgrove, three sturdy exponents of
private enterprise, while the Meije, the last of the great Alpine
peaks to be conquered, was climbed without guides by the
Pilkingtons and Frederick Gardiner in 1879, only two years after
it had first been climbed with professionals. The Pilkingtons,Lancashire business men, were typical of the second generation of
Alpine pioneers, men of strong character who sought in guideless
climbing and in the development of British mountaineering a
relaxation from the multiple duties ofa life crammed with service,
industry, and hard work, the coin in which the Victorians boughttheir leisure.
The apogee ofthe guideless climbing movement came early for
the Victorians, in this period of the young Hudson. "One is
much inclined to think that, at one period, these Hudsons, these
Smyths, these Ramsays, these Parkers, these Youngs, these
Buxtons, and others were within measurable distance ofdivertingthe stream of English mountaineering from the course it eventu-
ally took and of forming a great school of guideless English
climbers", wrote Captain Farrar, that great Alpine expert. As
history finally ordained it was only the experience of the
Second World War, combined with the financial stringency
imposed by post-war restrictions, that was to begin the formation
of such a school.
Hudson wrote but little. Together with Kennedy, he de-
scribed his ascent ofMont Blanc without guides in Where There's
a Will There s a Way, and to a second edition he added his account
of the Monte Rosa expedition. He contributed an occasional
paper to Peaks, Passes and Glaciers, and notes to the Alpine Journal.
Yet nowhere did he even begin to explain those inner reasons for
his obsession with mountaineering of which there are occasional
hints in his scanty writings.
This is more to be regretted because the development of
mountaineering during the later 1850*8 owed so much to the
books which its exponents were beginning to make available to an
ever-growing public. There had, ofcourse, been many mountain
books before the mid-fifties, but they had been written for a
restricted and almost family public. From the first ascent ofMont
75
Blanc, a whole succession of little pamphlets had appeared uponthe scene, something like four for every five ascents of the
mountain which had been made. They were detailed, honest, and
intimate little journals, telling exactly what had happened to the
conquerors, recording the names and weaknesses of the guides,
explaining what was, or was not, seen of the view from the
summit, and recording in understandable detail the great recep-
tion accorded in Chamonix to those who had paid some .30
apiece for the ascent. They were frequently subsidised by their
authors.
The little books were invariably slim, expensive, well bound,
well printed, illustrated by sketches or water-colours of those
artists who had known Mont Blanc at least at distant range, and
were sometimes privately produced for circulation almost
exclusively among the friends of those who had made the ascents
recorded. They make fascinating reading, but their contemporaryinfluence was negligible.
The mountain books of the mid-fifties were different. Even
Forbes' Travels through the Alps of Savoy, a book largely for
scientists, had contained much of interest to the general reader.
Wills' Wanderings, Hinchliff's Summer Months among the Alps,
Hudson's account of his Mont Blanc ascent, and, to a lesser
extent, The Spirit of Travel, a handy little book by that mountain-
connoisseur, Charles Packe, who travelled through both the
Pyrenees and the Lakes with his dogs all these books were
intended for the less clearly defined reader. Their circulation, even
so, was influential rather than large; their reviews were in the
right places and were discussed by the right people. They gave,to mountaineering in the later 1850'$, a position it would hardlyotherwise have occupied. They formed the bridgehead from
which the intellectual assault could be launched.
That the bridgehead was built up at all was largely the result of
a lucky chance which brought Hudson to Longmans, the pub-lishers. William Longman, later to become Vice-President and
then President of the Alpine Club, was at the time of Hudson's
ascent ofMont Blanc one of the heads of the firm. He not only
published Hudson's book but later in 1856 made his first Alpine
76
tour. He was forty-three at the time, and his age combined with
his family responsibilities to prevent him from ever seriously
tackling the business of mountaineering; yet he was fascinated
by the Alps and by all that he saw in them, and in the following
year gladly published Hinchliff's Summer Months among the Alps.
He was invited to become a member of the Alpine Club, and was
one of the moving spirits in the publication of Peaks, Passes and
Glaciers, as well as the publisher of a whole host of Alpine books
that included Wills' sequel to the Wanderings, TyndalTs Moun-
taineering in 1861, and Gilbert and Churchill's Dolomite Mountains,
the first account by Englishmen of the remarkable area a
mountain area through which, like many other Englishmen, theyhad first travelled on their respective honeymoons.
Longman, like most successful publishers, had most of his
fingers on the unpredictable pulse of the public. He sensed,
rightly as it turned out, that the isolated adventures which had
followed Forbes' explorations were already being transformed
into the permanent background and tradition ofa pastime with a
steadily increasing body of devotees.
The next move was obvious.
77
Chapter Three
THE ALPINE CLUBLove of mountains, like the love of nature is something
new, perhaps sophisticated.I cannot help that. In me
it is too deeply implanted to be rooted out.
HENRY W. NEVISON
THEgrowing interest in the new and frequently criticised
occupation of climbing mountains for pleasure must, in the
Victorian Age, have had one inevitable result. It was obvious
that a group of like-minded men would form themselves into a
club whose members would meet at pre-arranged intervals to
discuss the technical aspects of their interest, to exchange infor-
mation and, if the record of human nature stands for anything,to spur themselves on to further efforts.
The result was the Alpine Club the Alpine Club and not the
London Alpine Club or the British Alpine Club. There was no
need for any geographical location for this, the first organisation
of its kind; in any case, the calm clear assumption of superiority
fitted well into the spirit of the age. It had, after all, been the
Great Exhibition, unqualified by any adjective. The Alpine Club
therefore assumed, at its inception, a certain dictatorial Tightness
to which it had, it must be admitted, almost every possible claim.
It began in an age when it could, through the unique experienceof its members, speak, as it has spoken ever since, with somethingof the authority which belonged to the Delphic Oracle. There
was, at times, more than a hint ofGod about it. To the men whoformed the club nearly a century ago the communal views which
they expressed must have seemed, in an Alpine context, to be
rather like the voice of God Himself.
The earliest suggestion that an Alpine Club should be formed
came from William Mathews, the first of a long line of Alpinists
78
from the great Worcestershire family whose members swaminto success on the crest of the Victorian wave, in a letter to the
Rev. Fenton John Anthony Hort.
Hort, a typical Victorian ecclesiastic of great mental powerwhose equally vigorous climbing potentialities were limited byill-health and overwork, had been a friend of Mathews at
Cambridge and had made a number ofclimbs with him. He was
known even in his early days for sound common sense and
administrative ability, and it was natural that Mathews should
write to him. For Hort was then a Fellow of Trinity, a collegeto which a high percentage of the early climbers had belonged,and it was likely that he, above all other men, would be able to
judge the possibilities.
I want you to consider [said Mathews in his letter of February i,
1857] whether it would not be possible to establish an Alpine Club,
the members of which might dine together once a year,' say in
London, and give each other what information they could. Each
member, at the close ofany Alpine tour in Switzerland or elsewhere,
should be required to furnish, to the President, a short account of all
the undescribed excursions he had made, with a view to the publica-
tion of an annual or bi-annual volume. We should thus get a gooddeal of useful information in a form available to the members.
Hort agreed to the idea but feared that the dining might have
precedence over the information to be exchanged; care, he
warned, should be taken that the dinner bills were kept within
reasonable dimensions.
That summer Mathews visited the Alps with his cousin,
Benjamin St. John Attwood-Mathews, and together with Ken-
nedy they discussed the formation of an Alpine Club. Finally, on
the thirteenth of August they made the first English ascent of
the Finsteraarhorn, together with the Rev. J. F. Hardy, and a
Mr. Ellis. The success of the expedition further encouraged the
idea of a club and its formation was definitely decided upon. That
autumn William Mathews, his son, Mr. St. John Mathews, two
of his nephews, W. and C. E. Mathews, together with Kennedy,dined at William Mathews' home, The Leasowes, on the
79
outskirts of Birmingham the house where the young Edward
Whymper was later to tell Forbes the story of the Matterhorn
accident. The name of the house is still seen on even the quarter-
inch Ordnance Survey maps, retained, perhaps, by a carto-
grapher who knew not only that the poet Shenstone had lived
there but that it was the birthplace of the Alpine Club.
At The Leasowes dinner, Mathews and his friends drew uplists of men likely to join the Club; Kennedy, on his return to
London, either saw personally or wrote to all those on the various
lists. A few men showed little interest. The rest met at Ashley's
Hotel, Covent Garden, on December 22 and the Club was
formally established.
Kennedy had previously circulated a note listing the objects
and proposed rules ofthe Club, and it is obvious from some ofthe
reactions to this that the original idea of a dining club which
would meet once a year had already expanded considerably.
The chief point which raises doubt is the expense [wrote Hort,
who was unable to be present at the December 22 meeting]. Onwhat do you propose to expend guinea subscriptions and guinea
entrance fees? Surely there is nothing to be gained by having
"rooms", "curator", and that style of thing? William Mathews
wrote to me about such a club for one dinner nearly a year ago: and
I then told him I thought it would be an excellent thing, providedthe dinner bills were kept within reasonable dimensions. When he
was here a few weeks ago, he quite concurred; he was going to write
to you on the subject, but I have heard no more from him. Is it not
rather much to ask a guinea a year, besides two dinners and (for all
except Londoners) two double journeys to town? Granting that it
is desirable to make the club select, we cannot see that a moneystandard is a desirable one. It may be well to have a few books and
maps, though most of us would be likely to possess the best mapsof districts which we meant to visit; but their annual cost ought to
be something very small. Circulars would also cost something. But
these are the only necessary expenses we can think of (except in
connexion with dinners, which will, as you propose, be divided
among the diners) ;and they might annually be divided among the
whole Club without a large fixed subscription. What idea lurks
under "geographical explorers" and "other guests of celebrity"?
So
Surely we do not want speeches from Dr. Livingstone or Sir
Roderick Murchison? The introduction of such elements seems
likely to impair the genuineness of the whole affair.
In spite of such rather querulous complaints Hort became an
original member and remained a member until his death in 1892.
The one real controversy at the formation of the Club con-
sisted of the argument that soon developed around Rule XH.This laid it down that all candidates should have ascended to the
top of a mountain 13,000 ft. in height a curious qualification
since mountaineers had soon learned that height itself was rarely
a measure of difficulty. The rule was finally amended so that a
candidate's general mountaineering ability and experience, rather
than any one isolated effort, became the criterion. Furthermore,
it was made clear that, in certain cases, men who were not active
mountaineers might be eligible for membership. The objects of
the Club were, after all, defined as "the promotion of good
fellowship among mountaineers, of mountain climbing and
mountain exploration throughout the world, and ofbetter know-
ledge of the mountains through literature, science, and art".
Mr. John Ball, the Irish politician, scientist and traveller, whohad been Under-Secretary for the Colonies in Lord Palmerston's
Administration of 1855, was elected the first President of the Club
early in 1858. His choice was not due to the prestige afforded byhis name for at that time he was one of the most experienced of
all Alpine travellers; although he had made few spectacular
ascents, he had been travelling throughout the Alps for nearly
twenty years at the time of his election, had crossed the main
chain forty-eight times by thirty-two different passes, and had
traversed nearly 100 of the lateral passes.
The Club was now fully launched on the world, but not for
another year did it acquire permanent quarters. Its members
continued, instead, to meet in HinchlifFs chambers in Lincoln's
Inn and to hold their dinners in various hotels and private rooms.
The reason is explained by William Longman who some twenty
years later wrote a short history of the club and embarked on a
history of mountaineering whose completion was cut short byhis death.
81
It was at first assumed that the Club would take the character
rather of a social gathering of a few mountaineers than of a really
important society, at the meetings ofwhich papers were to be read,
and contributions made to the geographical and topographical
knowledge of mountain regions, and it certainly never entered into
the mind of any of its founders to conceive that it would be the
parent of fruitful children, each more prolific than itself.
Within a year, membership had risen to more than eighty.
By 1861 it had reached 158, and claims to membership were beingbased on "a list of literary contributions or mountain exploits".
The Club was expanding, not only as Hort had apparently feared,
into a wining and dining club, but into Longman's "really
important society". The less ascetic side of life was by no means
neglected, however, and Ellis Hardman, the "Victorian Pepys"as he has been called, has left a typical picture ofan annual summer
dinner.
Last night I dined at the Castle, Richmond, with the Alpine Club
[he wrote]. We found a jolly party round William Longman, the
publisher, who is Vice-President of the club, Anthony Trollope
sitting next to him. Longman is a glorious fellow, full ofjokes and
story, and beaming with good humour. Anthony Trollope is also
a good fellow, modelled on Silenus, with a large black beard.
There was a call for Trollope, and Silenus made a funny speech,
assuring the Club that he was most desirous ofbecoming a member,but the qualification was the difficulty, and both time and flesh
were against him. He added that not very long since, in the city
of Washington, a member of the U.S. Government asked him if it
were true that a club ofEnglishmen existed who held their meetingson the summits of the Alps. "In my anxiety", he said, "to supportthe credit of my country, I have transgressed the strict limits of
veracity, but I told him what he heard was quite true" (Great
cheers).
Through all the vicissitudes of the Club and it was rent, at
fairly regular intervals, by fierce arguments on policy, procedure,and almost everything else, which all the contestants appear
thoroughly to have enjoyed a certain civilised "clubbabiHty"remained uppermost. Small cliques or groups were formed from
82
time to time, though rarely for a more harmful purpose than
concentration on some specific Alpine problem or the gratifica-
tion of some mutual interest. This was true, for instance, of the
Club within a club whose headed note-paper bore an embossed
crest which included a black waiter on the left, a green guide onthe right, a black-and-blue shield in between and, below, the
words "Curre per alpes".
The history of the device on the paper is as follows [explainedA. W. Moore, one of the most enterprising and daring climbers of
the i86o's, and one of the first to climb in the Caucasus], A small
number of A.C.'s have for years past dined together before the
meetings, and the device is their private property, now supersededfor postcards! The man in black symbolises a waiter, he in greena guide the sole idea ofthe community being dining and climbing.The bloody hand grasps a carving knife. The falling figure is
prophetic of the fate which will not improbably befall us, while the
Chamois grins with serene happiness from the elevated and exalted
position which the faller vainly strove to reach! Altogether a
cheerful allegory!
The facts, dates, and figures ofthe early members ofthe AlpineClub have been tabulated in a great labour of love, the three-
volume Alpine Club Register which was compiled over long years
of careful research by the late A. L. Mumm. From this Sir
Arnold Lunn has abstracted figures showing that of the first
281 members ofthe Club those who joined it between 1857 and
1863 fifty-seven were practising barristers, twenty-three were
solicitors, and thirty-four were clergymen, with landed gentry and
dons coining next with nineteen and fifteen respectively. Many of
the Club's early members, however, had little more than a passing
interest in mountaineering. Matthew Arnold "everyone should
see the Alps once, to know what they are" was a member. So
was Wilfrid Scawen Blunt. Sir Richard Burton was elected
(although he never completed his membership), his qualification
being "General travel; mountain ranges in all parts ofthe world".
So was Thomas Atkinson, from Cawthorne, Yorkshire, that odd
traveller ofhumble origin, a bricklayer's labourer and quarrymanwho rose to fame through his architectural ability, travelled across
83
much of Central Asia for the Tsar, and on his return to Britain
succeeded in maintaining a position of some public importance
despite the fact that he had two wives living in Britain simul-
taneously, a feat by no means common even today.
Once those members who had little genuine interest in moun-
taineering are removed from the total, the preponderance of
lawyers, business men, and clergy is even more marked. Most of
these were men of considerable learning and scanty leisure. It
is significant that for almost all of them travel among the highmountains was not only a pleasant relaxation but something that
appeared to influence much of their lives. There were two main
reasons for this, the first physical and obvious, explainable most
easily by the example of the hardest workers among the business
men and the lawyers; the second more undefined, more difficult
of definition, more explicable by die examples of the clergymenand of the scientists.
Many of the Victorians climbed because they found in the
mountains the greatest escape from, the greatest contrast to, their
normal, densely packed life. At first, as was natural, they went
to the Alps. Later, as climbing techniques improved, as the majorand then the minor peaks ofthe Alps were climbed, a few ofthem
looked farther afield for their relaxation. Charles Packe in the
Pyrenees, Douglas Freshfield in the Caucasus, and Cecil Slingsbyin Norway, all brought the principles of sound mountaincraft,
developed in the Alps almost entirely by British climbers, to
lands which knew little of such matters.
Most cosmopolitan ofthem all was Freshfield, who made three
journeys to the Caucasus, led an expedition to the Himalayawhere he was seen on occasion in grey cut-away tail-coat and
trousers and who also climbed in South Africa, the Ruwenzori,the Canadian Rockies, and the Japanese Alps. Yet however
attractive such ventures might be, lack of time and money pro-hibited them for most mountaineers, to whom they appeared as
isolated and rather exotic departures from the main sport of
Alpine climbing.
The one exception to this was formed by the explorations in
Norway of Cecil Slingsby, that great Yorkshireman, Elizabethan
84
!!%
lip ml V# H 1
*
|| ||
[
| |ff| H
\\ 11 If! itfc* ,I,Aa.A,,ii ....*, , ^...i!L_. ..rf*,*iwM.,2I
II John Tyndall (bearded) outside the Bel Alp with his Wife, 1876
12 The Rev. Hereford George's Party on the Lower Grindelwald Glacier, 1865
13 Lawrence and Charles Pilkington and (centre) Frederick Gardiner, in the late
ofboth frame and outlook, with, a name still not only known buthonoured in the most unexpected of small Norwegian hamlets.
Slingsby spent five seasons in Norway before he visited the
Alps. Later he played an important part in the development of
climbing in Britain and when, during the i88o's and 1890*8, hecarried out his major Alpine campaigns they consisted largely of
guideless climbs whose main attractions lay on rock rather thanim ice or snow. His traditions, therefore, did not spring so
directly from those of the Alpine pioneers as did most of his
contemporaries. With mountaineering he linked not science but
art; in the mountains he saw not a laboratory but a field for newhuman experiences which would make every day brighter andbetter.
To understand why men of his calibre devoted themselves to a
sport still under criticism, it is necessary only to consider the recordof C. E. Mathews, a benign and much-loved Birmingham manwho was an early prototype of the Alpine Club member.Mumm's summary that for nearly fifty years Mathews made
himself felt in countless ways in the public and social life of Bir-
mingham is an understatement. WithJoseph Chamberlain, oneof his greatest friends, Mathews was a founder of the NationalEducation League. He was chairman ofinnumerable committees,
president of innumerable societies, a Birmingham Town Coun-cillor, a governor of schools, a leader in local politics, a Justice ofthe Peace, and an active and opinionated member of a whole
galaxy of bodies. He managed to pack all this activity into
seventy-one crowded years, to become also, as well as one of the
most accomplished mountaineers of his day, an expert of im-
portance on subjects as varied as the Waterloo Campaign, the
Birmingham Water Supply, and the detailed history of MontBlanc.
The mountains provided the clue to this extraordinary energy.Mathews was the text-book example of the man who went
climbing to escape not from any unpleasant facts of life but
from the crowded events which his own high standards of dutypushed relentlessly on to his shoulders.
At the bivouacs or in the mountain hotels of the Alps, at the
V.M. 5 87
cottage which he later acquired at Machynlleth, in North Wales,
Charles Edward Mathews could slough off the responsibilities of
Birmingham. Here, he knew, was a relaxation, a safety-valve
such as no other sport could possibly provide. Here, surrounded
only by amiable companions who like himself wished for a time
to turn their backs at least until the end of the month on the
progress which they had helped to create; surrounded, also, bythat new race ofmen which he had helped to raise from the raw
material of the guides; here Mathews and men of similar thoughtwere able to forget the pulsing, scrambling, gainfully employedlife of England's expanding industrial empire.
Mathews played an important part in creating the guides as an
honourable and respected group of men. For hundreds of years
local peasants had been available for leading travellers across the
easy snow passes ofthe Alps. Some ofthem had helped Hannibal,
and their ancestors' ancestors had done much the samejob for the
men of the Middle Ages who had succeeded in keeping open the
great trans-Alpine trade routes. Yet the whole virtue of these
men was that they could lead others across mountains rather than
up them; they would look, instinctively, for the nick in a skyline
rather than for the ridge that led to a summit. Many were goodand brave men; many more merited Whymper's description
of "pointers out ofpaths, and large consumers ofmeat and drink,
but little more".
It needed mountaineers such as Wills and Mathews, as the Rev.
Hereford George and Leslie Stephen, to raise up a certain number
ofAlpine peasants, to breath fire into them and to stir into them a
knowledge which was eventually to make them the first mem-bers of a great profession. In an unexpected way, the Alpine
pioneers mixed as perfect equals with these peasants whom theyhired. There was something more to it than the remark of one
guide to his employer on a mountain that: "You are master in the
valley; I am master here." Reading back through the record,
catching what one can from the memories that remain, one can
really believe that in this way at least some of the Victorians did
practise the theory that all men are born equal. "They were just
like brothers", said the daughter of one famous amateur and the
guide with whom he climbed regularly for more than a quarter
of a century.
"To say that I owe him a debt impossible to pay is not to say
much," Mathews wrote of Melchior Anderegg, the guide with
whom he spent most ofhis climbing life, andwhom he personally
guided round the Snowdon Horseshoe on one memorable
occasion when Melchior was staying with him in his cottage in
North Wales.
He first taught me how to climb. For more than 20 seasons he
has led me in success and failure in sunshine and in storm. Hehas rejoiced with me in happy tunes; he has nursed me when
suffering from accident with a charming devotion. Year after yearI have met him with keener pleasure. Year after year I have partedfrom him with a deeper regret.
Mathews' introduction to the Alps was a hearty one during the
season of 1856 when with his brother, William Mathews, he
ascended the Dent du Midi, was turned back by weather on Mont
Blanc, and during the course of three weeks' successful climbingcrossed a number of passes and climbed a number of peaks,
including Monte Rosa.
The following year he returned to the Alps, met Melchior
Anderegg, and embarked on that long Alpine career that took
him to the mountains almost every year until the turn of the
century when, at the age of sixty-five, he was reluctantly com-
pelled to give up mountaineering. He had had forty seasons,
climbed both the Matterhorn and the Wetterhorn three times, the
Monch twice, Monte Rosa five times and Mont Blanc no less
than twelve.
Mathews, inevitably, went to the Alps for his honeymoon, and
during the holiday attempted the Blumlisalphorn, climbed the
Altels, was turned back on the south face of the Weisshorn, and
ascended the Jungfrau with Horace Walker, the Liverpool
merchant who together with Mathews was to play such an
important part, nearly a quarter ofa century later, in the develop-ment of climbing in Britain.
Mathews, the epitome of that comfortable God-fearing groupof middle-class Englishmen who believed that the Almighty had
89
deliberately put diem into positions of responsibility, was
charitable, overworked, but only mildly critical of the appalling
conditions in which large numbers of his countrymen lived.
Perhaps the most characteristic quality of his climbing, and of all
that is known about him, was his "clubbability". In this, as well
as in his established background and his physical motives for
climbing, he was typical of a considerable segment of Alpine
Club members. The ascent of a fine peak was, with Mathews,
one part ofa day's adventuring in which comradeship with others,
the ordered progressionofthe day from dawn to dusk, the shared
enjoyment of fine sights and experiences,the new experience in
the regular march of life, all merged to make one civilised and
civilising experience.
Few men did more than Mathews to consolidate the founda-
tions of climbing in Britain. With his home on the outskirts of
Birmingham it was natural that holidays too short for enjoyment
in the Alps should be spent in North Wales, where he climbed
Snowdon more than 100 times and Cader Idris more than 100.
It was Mathews who did so much to bring fame and fortune to
Pen-y-Gwryd, the little inn standing where the road from Capel
Curig forks uphill towards the summit of the Llanberis Pass and
downhill towards the distant gleam of Llyn Gwynant. Here, in
1870, he founded the "Society ofWelsh Rabbits", a small group
of friends banded together to explore Snowdonia in winter, and
it was Mathews who played an important part in the foundation,
in 1898, of the Climbers' Club, of which he was to become first
President.
He was an honorary member of both the Yorkshire Ramblers
Club and of the Rucksack Club. He was an adviser, a man of
experience whose views, all knew, would be completely dis-
interested as well as fully informed. He was utterly reliable and
fair, and in his later days occupied much the same position as that
filled half a century later by Geoffrey Winthrop Young.
Mathews represented all those constant qualities of which
civilisation is compounded. For the Alpine Club he might well
have been a symbol, the "typical climbing man" against whose
character and record the critics might beat in vain.
90
Chapter Four
THE SCIENTISTSThe sea offaithWas once, too, at thefull, and round earth's shore
Lay like thefolds ofa bright girdlefurl9
d.
But now I only hear
Its melancholy, long, withdrawing roar.
MATTHEW ARNOLD
MATHEWSwas typical of that large body of Alpine Club
members who found in the mountains the complete and
incomparable break from the Victorian world which they had
helped to create. Yet to escape into the mountains was only one
incentive for the climbers of the Golden Age; the demands of
science formed another.
The early scientists who first solved the basic problems ofhighmountain-travel had their counterparts a decade or more later in
such men as Bonney, Tuckett, Ramsay, John Ball, and Tyndall.
Some were to help in the development of mountain-wanderinginto the craft of mountain-cHmbing; some were to see the trans-
formation of the craft into the organised sport of the twentieth
century.
The scientists of mountaineering's Golden Age can be divided
into the amateurs and the professionals. There were those such as
Francis Fox Tuckett, a man bristling with note-books and instru-
ments, an indefatigable and earnest amateur whom hard times
never limited, a lucky man whose mountain and scientific
inclinations happily coincided. And there were the professionals
such as Tyndall, the poor boy from County Carlow, whose
scientific work took him into die mountains, the boy who later
found circumstance taking him to the mountains year after year
and himself going to them for love alone. The amateurs had the
mountain passion earlier in their lives than the professionals, and
moulded their lives to fit their inclinations. The professionals
were captured unawares by the mountains, often in middle life;
their passion appears to have been deeper and more disturbing
because of this fact.
There were, of course, those men such as Bonney, a scientific
Mathews, who in all difficult problems returned again and again
to the mountains for a solution. With Bonney, as with so manyof the Victorian mountaineers, it is his energy and his many-
sidedness that astound. At the age of sixty he walked from his
hotel to the top of the Piz Languard, an ascent of about 4,800 ft.,
"without a single pause", as he proudly puts it. Well past the
age of seventy he maintained his regular seven miles a day, fair
weather or bad, and at the age of eighty was still capable of
what his not uncritical Alpine friends called strenuous days on the
hills. His range ofinterests was of the size which might have been
expected of that rarity, the geologising parson. To the climber,
Bonney is the man of twenty-seven who unsuccessfully tackled
the Pelvoux when even its position was unknown two years
before Whymper visited the Dauphin6. To the geologist he is
one of the pioneers.To the ecclesiastics, one of those preachers
who remained calm and undismayed by the terrors of Darwin.
He was a mountain sketcher of considerable ability, an extensive
producer of books and sermons, an architectural artist of almost
professional skill, and the writer ofmore than 200 separate articles,
mostofthem in the full-bodied many-columned fashion ofthe day.
Thomas George Bonney was only eight or nine when he was
first impressed by a great mountain view that ofSnowdon from
the garden of the Royal Hotel at Capel Curig, looking to the
mountains across the Mymbyr Lakes. It was a view that he never
forgot, and its effect remained with him for the rest of his life.
At the age oftwenty-three he made his first visit to Switzerland,
a rather routine visit with a reading party during which he
journeyed across the Mer de Glace but did no serious climbing.
He took Holy Orders his religious service was almost entirely
limited to two years as curate at St. John the Evangelist, West-
minster and, later in life, two years as Cambridge Preacher at the
Chapel Royal, Whitehall and returned to the Alps two years
92
after his first visit. He crossed a number of passes, became
interested in the problems of high climbing, and returned the
following year to climb the Altels and Monte Rosa.
It was in 1860 that he turned to the Dauphine, driven there
largely by the zest that is, as he put it, "given to the pleasurederived from the beauties of nature by the knowledge that theyhave been seldom or never seen by others".
Forbes* notes on Dauphine, published seven years earlier, com-
prised all the printed information available. The atlases, com-ments Bonney, did not recognise the existence of mountains in
that part of France, while the most reliable map of the countrywhich had been made was that of Bourcet which had been com-
pleted more than a century ago in days when the presence of
dragons in the Alps was first being seriously disputed.
With the spread of mountaineering in the sixties, the inns of
the Dauphine became notorious, and there is little doubt that theywere far more ill-kempt than those of the rest of the Alps.
Bonney's description ofwhat faced him and his party consisting
of the ubiquitous William Mathews andJohn Clarke Hawkshaw,a Manchester civil engineer who remained a member of the
Alpine Club until his death in 1921 though he had not climbed
since the 1860 season was not, however, so very untrue of the
rest of the Alps in the days of the pioneers.
On the great high road from Grenoble to Brian^on there is fair
accommodation at one or two places [he said]. Off this, everything
is ofthe poorest kind; fresh meat can only be obtained at rare intervals,
the bread and wine are equally sour, the auberges filthy, and the beds
entomological vivaria. It is hardly possible to conceive the squalid
misery in which the people live; their dark dismalhuts swarming with
flies, fleas, and other vermin; the broom, the mop and the scrubbing
brush are unknown luxuries; the bones and refuse of a meal are
flung upon the floor to be gnawed by dogs, and are left there to
form an osseous brecia. The people in many parts are stunted,
cowardly and feeble, and appear to be stupid and almost cretins.
Too often there, as in other parts of the Alps, "every prospect
pleases and only man is vile".
When it came to the "entomological vivaria", Bonney's
93
scientific knowledge was useful. There was the time, he recalls,
when he and a companion had the choice of two beds in a verysmall inn. One of the beds looked relatively trim; the other was
filthy. They tossed a coin, Bonney won and took the filthy bed.
In the morning his companion found that while he had been
wracked with insects, Bonney had been untroubled.
"Yes," he quietly explained, "I chose the iron bedstead; they
don't breed them/'
On the mountains one was apt to have similarly unpleasant
surprises. In 1860, when Bonney and his companions set out to
climb Mont Pelvoux, then still vaguely thought to be the highest
peak in the Dauphin^, they had been told of a rough hut on the
mountain in which they could bivouac. Finally the guide
pointed it out:
a huge mass of rock that had in former times fallen down from the
cliffs above, and had rested so as to form a shelter under one of its
sides. This had been still further enclosed with a rough wall of
loose stones, and thus a sort of kennel was made, about nine or ten
feet by five or six, and about four feet high at the entrance, whence
it sloped gradually down to about two feet at the other end.
Finally, the party was turned back by bad weather, as it was
two days later on Monte Viso, and Bonney moved south to Turin
with Hawkshaw, finally going to Zermatt over the Theodule and
spending the rest of his holiday in the Zermatt area.
The remoteness of the Dauphine fascinated Bonney as it was
later to fascinate others, and to it he returned again and again in
the following years until he finally became, with Tuckett and
Coolidge, one of the greatest British experts on the group. His
travels took him, however, to almost every part of the Alps.
First a Lecturer in Geology at St. John's, then, for a quarter of a
century, a Professor of Geology at University College, London,he became increasingly aware of the vast number of scientific
problems which could be solved in the laboratory of the Alpsfar more easily and conveniently than elsewhere.
The extent of his wanderings is shown by the fact that in
thirty-five seasons he made about no ascents, six of them above
10,000 ft., and crossed more than 170 passes.
94
Less of a professional scientist than Bonney, more of a moun-taineer, yet the man even more responsible than Coolidge for the
encyclopaedic approach to the Alps, was John Ball, the AlpineClub's first President. The creator of Peaks, Passes and Glaciers
and, through that, of the Alpine Journal, as well as of the AlpineGuide] Ball was not only politician and amateur scientist but,
more than these things, a gentleman of leisure, treading the
familiar path from University to Bar and then devoting himself
to those useful pursuits in which men of less time and less moneycould not indulge. He was, almost alone among the early British
mountaineers, a prominent Catholic.
Like Bonney, Ball was first influenced by mountains at the
early age of nine when he first saw the Alps from the Col de la
Faucille. Perhaps nothing, he said later, had had so great an
influence on his entire life.
He was, as might have been expected from a Catholic, moreinterested than Bonney, or most contemporary scientists, in the
spiritual experiences which the mountains offered. While in manyways typical of the Victorian amateur scientist, begirt with note-
books, he yet had a genuine love ofpioneering work which went
far beyond his note-taking needs. It was the interest ofmaking a
difficult passage, rather than any scientific urgency, which com-
pelled him in 1845 to press on with his crossing of the Schwartz-
thor, on which he finally led his incompetent guide across the
pass. It was the same reason, twelve years later, which impelledhim to press on to the summit ofthe Pelmo, one of the first greatDolomite peaks to be climbed.
It was possibly in 1845, the year in which he was called to the
Irish Bar, that Ball first appreciated how well mountain-wander-
ing might be combined with his scientific observations. He
spent some time at Zermatt, chiefly engaged in the double task of
exploring the remarkable vegetation of the Valley of St. Nicholas,
and of observing the movement of the two nearest glaciers. Heclimbed the RifFelhorn, made a number of glacier excursions,
then returned to Zermatt and made the first passage of the
Schwartzthor.
Thereafter he travelled in the Alps almost every year until his
95
death in 1889, covering their whole breadth by his excursions,
making new ascents wherever these fitted into his plan for fresh
botanical or geological observations, but travelling rather than
climbing, gaining knowledge of a whole area rather than"work-
ing out" any one valley, a process which might, had he adopted
it, have given him a list of first ascents as fine as that of any of his
contemporaries. By 1863, when the first volume of his Alpine
Guide appeared, he had crossed the main Alpine chain forty-eight
rimes by thirty-two different passes and had in addition traversed
nearly 100 lateral passes a record which at that time was unique.
Ball has left a description of how he travelled and what he
took with him, a description which cannot be very dissimilar
from that ofmost scientists ofthe time who carried their amateur
researches into the Alps.
To my knapsack [he observed] is strapped a stout piece of ropeabout thirty feet long, with a Scotch plaid and umbrella; the last,
though often scoffed at, is an article that hot sunshine, even more
than rain, has taught me to appreciate. A couple of thermometers,
a pocket klinometer, and a Rater's compass with prismatic eye-piece,
may be carried in suitable pockets, along with a note-book and a
sketch-book, having a fold for writing-paper, etc., a good opera-
glass, which I find more readily available than a telescope; strong
knife, measuring tape, a veil, and spectacles, leather cup, spare cord,
and matches. A flask with strong cold tea, to be diluted with water
or snow, a tin box for plants, a geological hammer of a form
available for occasional use as an ice-axe, with a strap to keep all
right, and prevent anything from swinging loosely in awkward
places, complete the accoutrement.
The fact that Ball's journeys were planned with eyes on
scientific rather than mountaineering records is well illustrated
by the list. It was not, however, so strange that it was Ball whowas asked to fill the Presidency of the Alpine Club in 1858, an
office left vacant when the Committee had been elected. His
position in the world, his administrative ability, and his retirement
from politics early in 1858 which gave him the time to devote to
a pleasant hobby-horse, all combined to make him an ideal manfor the post, especially as the Club at that time represented a
96
pastime whose aims and ideals were, at the best, imperfectlyunderstood. There was also not only Ball's Alpine record but the
feeling that his particular brand of knowledge would enrich the
Club, arising as it did from his practice in the orderly, logical
presentation of facts. The Club had not long to wait.
In November, Ball wrote to William Longman.
Among the crowd of tourists who leave England every year,a good many visit places of interest in the Alps and elsewhere, that
are nearly or quite unknown to the reading public. A fair propor-tion ofthem are capable ofwriting an intelligible and even interesting
account ofwhat they have done and seen, but with limited materials
it is neither reasonable nor desirable that each should write a book.
What would you say to bringing out an annual volume, made up of
contributions of travellers? If carefully selected, I should say that
such a volume would be generally interesting, and secure of a large
sale. Unlike the books ofmost travellers, the writers would have no
occasion to stuff their articles with additional matter taken out of
libraries; there would be room for small contributions to science,
especially Natural History, but in that department especially I
would advise you (if you should adopt the idea and undertake the
editing) to use much stricter restraint than most book-writingtravellers exercise over themselves. People of limited information
are apt to record facts which are either akeady well known and
familiar to men of science, or else wanting in the needful precision
and accuracy. A little previous communication with the writers
might sometimes convert a loose statement into a useful fact.
Thus, with an aim that was more scientific than Alpine, there
was born the germ that developed into Peaks, Passes and Glaciers,
A Series of Excursions by Members of the Alpine Club. The first
volume in the series, in which there were recorded many of the
now near-legendary exploits of the pioneers, was published by
Longmans early in 1859, under Ball's editorship. By the end of
the year it had gone through four editions totalling 2,500 copies,
and a fifth edition was issued in the following year. Two more
volumes, edited by E. S. Kennedy, and illustrated by woodcuts
prepared by Whymper, appeared in 1862, and their success
confirmed the earlier impression that a "regular market" now
97
existed for chronicles of Alpine exploration. The next year there
followed the Alpine Journal, that*
'record of mountain adventure
and scientific observation" that has remained the weightiest if not
the final word on all matters of Alpine history, topography, and
etiquette.
Great as were the benefits which the publication ofsuch material
accorded the climbers of the mid-sixties, they were as nothing
compared with the lasting effect of Ball's Alpine Guide. As early
as 1861, Ball had pointed out to a meeting of the Club that there
existed no guide-book for mountaineers that dealt with the whole
chain of the Alps. The result was his commission to produce such
a guide, and the eventual publication of his great trilogy, Guide
to the Western Alps (1863), Guide to the Central Alps (1864) and
Guide to the Eastern Alps (1868). Scores of helpers were co-optedinto the work, their information being sifted, checked, and
edited by Ball, who was in a vast number of cases able to tally the
facts and figures against his own experience. "Ball", together with
Peaks, Passes, and the volumes of the AlpineJournal itself, became
one of the craft's Sacred Works, and one which, unaltered, was
regularly consulted until its rewriting and reissue by Coolidgeat the end of the century.
Second only to Ball in the extent of his Alpine wanderings, in
his encyclopaedic and scientific approach to the mountains, and
in the earnest vigour with which he carried out his campaigns,was Francis Fox Tuckett, the Bristol Quaker and business manwho between 1856 and 1874 climbed 165 peaks, 84 of them
important summits, and crossed some 376 passes. No less than
57 new expeditions were included in these figures, an indication
that Tuckett's scientific interest was well tempered with the desire
for pioneer work.
Like Mathews, he packed an astonishing amount ofwork into
every day. Discussing one of his mountain campaigns with
Coolidge for nearly a month they once wrote one another a
letter every other day he mentions in passing that he is writing
thirty or forty letters a day, running his complicated and exten-
sive business, and is also busy with an cxecutorship and sundry
trusteeships.
After a visit to Switzerland as a child Tuckett returned in 1854,
at the age of twenty, for a long rambling tour. Two years later
he met Forbes and was imbued by him with the need for con-
tributing to the body of scientific knowledge, whatever else he
did in the Alps. "Make mountaineering not merely a recreation,
but a scientific occupation*' is reputed to have been the gist of
Forbes' exhortation.
Tuckett followed the advice, and the majority of his journeyswere made with all the equipment necessary for detailed obser-
vation and recording. He bristled with instruments, and his deep
pockets were filled with a series of elaborately organised note-
books and pencils ready both for making the pleasing panoramaswhich graced his records and for their detailed annotation.
He was a sight to see [said Hort in 1861], being hung from head
to foot with "notions" in the strictest sense of the word, several of
them being inventions ofhis own. Besides such commonplace thingsas a great axe-head and a huge rope and thermometers, he had two
barometers, a sypsieometer, and a wonderful apparatus, pot within
pot, for boiling water at great heights, first for scientific and then
for culinary purposes.
It is easy to ask why all this conglomeration of scientific
impedimenta was needed. The answer is that there were still men,even in the early days of "sporting" mountaineering, who
genuinely considered that any failure to record a multitude of
facts, figures, and dates, would be a back-sliding in social and
moral duty. They may have been right.
Even so, a sense of proportion was needed, and Tuckett's
ponderous contributions to Peaks, Passes and Glaciers invoked
Leslie Stephen's mock-heroic account of an ascent of the Gabel-
horn. On this famous climb, the scientists discovered the tempera-ture by the amount of cold on their fingers, for the thermometer
was broken, and found it to be 175 degrees below zero; their
height was so great that the mercury in the barometer sunk out
of sight. "As to ozone," said Stephen, "if there were any ozone
that afternoon on that arete, ozone must be a greater fool than I
take it to be." Professor Tyndall, for whom the Alpine Club rules
99
had been altered so that he might become Vice-President,
resigned in protest after Stephen's bantering speech, thinking the
barbs meant for him.
There was, in fact, less reason for Stephen to jibe at Tyndallthan at Tuckett. Tyndall was taken to the mountains by the
practical business of earning his own living and to him men like
Tuckett must have been rather ponderous dilettantes, however
charming their character might be and however useful might be
the vast gathering ofinformation on which they lavished so muchof their time, hardiness, and money.
Information Tuckett certainly did gather, ream upon ream of
it, both during his own high mountain excursions and on the less
strenuous tours which he made in middle life with his sisters.
Throughout the i86o's and iSyo's he returned, year after year,
to the Alps, climbing with most of the mountaineers of the day;
getting his one, or more, first ascent per season; planting his
thermometers carefully on peaks and passes where they could be
consulted, and their readings taken, by later travellers; winningfrom the King of Italy the Order of St. Maurice and St. Lazarus
for his scientific and geographical investigations in the Alps; and
only refusing the Presidency of the Alpine Club because he felt
that residence in or near London was essential to the job. Slow,
rather ponderous one must imagine, with an almost Germanic
lack of humour, Tuckett yet ventured in his measured stride
on the verge of more narrow escapes than most of his more
adventurous contemporaries. There was the famous time be-
neath the Eiger when his party escaped destruction beneath
an avalanche by a matter of feet, an escape described in A Race
for Life. He was arrested as a spy on the Austrian frontier in
1866, and three years later as a Panslavist agitator; while, right
at the end of his last season of hard climbing, in 1875, he finished
his final expedition by taking cover on the Roche Melon in
a chapel which was almost immediately partially destroyed by
lightning.
Tuckett had at least one thing in common both with Forbes,
the master who had preceded him, and with Tyndall, his fiery
contemporary. All three believed that it was the moral duty of
100
the mountaineer, the man moving up into new kingdoms, to
equip himself mentally and physically for carrying out the
maximum number of useful scientific observations. Forbes had
found a certain pleasure outside these observations. So did
Tuckett in a rather shame-faced sort of way. Tyndall took his
observations seriously, for they were both his life's-work and his
bread-and-butter. Yet without a hint of inconsistency he
admitted the glory of climbing for its own unscientific sake.
What is more, he explained the fact with a clarity which itself
explains the motives of Mathews and his kind and took the
argument one step farther.
I have returned to them every year [Tyndall wrote of the Alps],
and found among them refuge and recovery from the work and the
worry which acts with far deadlier corrosion on the brain than real
work of London. Herein consisted the fascination of the Alps for
me; they appealed at once to thought and feeling, offering their
problems to one and their grandeur to the other, while conferring
upon the body the soundness and the purity necessary to the
healthful exercise of both.
The belief in this dual function of mountains was almost the
only thing that Forbes and Tyndall had in common. Only twelve
years separated their births but in social background and religious
beliefs, Forbes belonged to the eighteenth century and Tyndallto the nineteenth. Forbes, his whole life conditioned by a wealthyand conservative family background, saw the Alps for the first
time on a "Grand Tour" that was almost part of the social round.
Tyndall saw them first on the student's walking tour of 1849 of
which he later said that"trusting to my legs and stick, repudiating
guides, eating bread and milk, and sleeping when possible in the
country villages where nobody could detect my accent, I got
through amazingly cheap". Even in their religious beliefs, the
contrast between Forbes and Tyndall was striking, Forbes feeling
the principles ofthe Church as governing his everyday habits and
actions in a way that was near-medieval; Tyndall remaining, in
spite of all his efforts, the confirmed agnostic who wished for no
stone to be raised above his grave.
101
In spite of all these differences it was Tyndall who occupied in
the mountaineering world of the i86o's the pre-eminent position
that Forbes had occupied a decade earlier. Both had a good back-
ground of what the Victorians called substantial worth; both
could only with danger be accused ofrashness or imprudence, and
the journalist who wrote the famous leading article in The Times
after the Matterhorn disaster "Is it life? Is it duty? Is it commonsense? Is it allowable? Is it not wrong?" must have had some
anxious moments wondering if Tyndall would open a broadside
against the attack. Much of TyndalTs importance to the Vic-
torian mountaineers and their development lay just in this fact;
that he was an unassailable, stabilising body whose scientific
theories might be questioned only with care, whose religious
doubts might be deplored, but whose interest in the new sport of
mountain-climbing was an inexplicable fact that must be accepted
as the idiosyncrasy of an intellectual heavyweight whom it would
be unwise to cross.
TyndalTs first holiday walking tour in 1849 took him from the
quiet German university town of Marburg (where von Papenwas later to make his one unavailing denouncement ofthe Nazis).
On September 19 he marched south, arriving at Heidelberg three
days later in the true fifty-mile-a-day fashion that he retained until
late in life. In Heidelberg he decided, as he wrote later, to "see
how the mountains appeared under such a sky. In those days it
was a pleasure to me to saunter along the roads enjoying such
snatches ofscenery as were thus attainable. I knew not the distant
mountains; the attraction which they afterwards exercised uponme had not yet begun to act/'
What is more, it failed to act even when he came within sight
ofthe Alps, perhaps because ofhis unfortunate approach, through
Zurich, Zug, and Arth to the Rigi, the notorious Rigi where,
thirty years later, the immortal Tartarin of Alphonse Daudet was
to be surprised by "that immense hotel, the Rigi-Kulm, glazedlike an observatory, massive as a citadel, wherein for a day and a
night a crowd of sun-worshipping tourists is located". For
Tyndall it was, rather similarly, merely a cloudy mountain noted
for its guzzling and its noise.
102
14 Ulrich Aimer saving his Employers on the Ober Gabelhorn, 1880
From a hawing by H. G. Willink
LESLIE STEPHEN
15 With his Guide, Melchior
Anderegg
1 6 On one of his later visits
to Grindelwald
He continued farther into Switzerland, saw the Rhone Glacier,
had an awkward scramble to the Grimsel after he had lost his way,crossed the Little Scheidegg where he saw the avalanches on the
Jungfrau, and then turned back for home. "The distant aspectof the Alps appeared to be far more glorious than the nearer
view", he commented, in an almost Ruskinian manner that was
enough to show that he had not, by then, been intrigued bymountains at first hand.
His conversion was not to start until seven years later when,
following his interest in the problems posed by the cleavage of
slates, he went to Switzerland in the hope ofbeing able to answer
the questions by investigating the glaciers. The journey was
made with Professor Huxley, and Tyndall proudly recalls that he
received his alpenstock from the hands of Dr. Hooker, in the
garden of the Pension Ober, at Interlaken. Thence, he set out ona tour that included visits to the Guggi, the Lower Grindelwald,
the Unteraar and the Rhone Glaciers a tour from which it
might well be claimed that there was to spring all his later pre-
occupation with mountaineering.
TyndalTs interest in the subject appears to have gone throughtwo distinct phases. There was first the era of scientific enquirythat began to change in 1859; and there was an era of the great
expeditions which followed 1859, many of them still linked to
important scientific enquiries but planned also with the aim of
mountain conquest.
It is possible that TyndalTs love of the Alps was born in 1856,
during his scientific ramble with Huxley. His description ofwhat
he calls the exceedingly grand scene on the Little Scheidegg is
revealing.
The upper air [he said] exhibited a wild commotion which we did
not experience; clouds were driven wildly against the flanks of the
Eiger, the Jungfrau thundered behind, while in front of us a magni-ficent rainbow, fixing one of its arms in the valley of Grindelwald
and, throwing the other right over the Wetterhorn, clasped the
mountain in its embrace. Through the jagged apertures in the
clouds, floods of golden light were poured down the sides of the
mountain. On the slopes were innumerable chalets, glistening in the
V.M. 6 105
stint_ ^nbeams, herds browsing peacefullyand shaking their mellow bells;
while the blackness of the pine-trees,crowded into woods, or
scattered in pleasant clusters over alps and valley, contrasted forcibly
with the lively green ofthe fields.
This was the description not only of the scientist but of the
embryo mountain-enthusiast and it was hardly surprising that
Tyndall went back the following year, by this time greatly
involved in the glacier argument and already at loggerheads with
Forbes. He stayed at the Montanvert for six weeks, taking
measurements as Forbes had done, crossed the Col du Geant, and
ascended Mont Blanc with a boy.
Once he got among the mountains, Tyndall appears to have
shown a sense for hill form and scenery almost entirely alien to
the rest of his life, inclinations, and aptitudes. Almost as soon, he
developed a love of daring mountain adventures, many ofwhich
such as his solitary ascent of Monte Rosa in 1858 with merely
a bottle of tea and a ham sandwich as supplies would have been
rashness in the case ofany man less competent.
The competence showed itself immediately Tyndall took to
serious climbing, and from the later 1850*8 his record is a peculiar
mixture ofhigh ascents which would have been "pure" mountain
ascents in the case of any other man but which were, in his case,
carried out largely for scientific motives, and of hit-and-thrust
exploits which equalled those of any member of the Alpine
Club.
In 1858 he climbed the Finsteraarhorn to make observations
from its summit while Ramsay made comparable measurements
from the Rhone Valley, thousands of feet lower. The following
year he made his famous ascent of Mont Blanc with Sir Alfred
Wills and August Balmat, during which the latter placed im-
portant scientific instruments in the summit-snow and nearly lost
his hands by frost-bite in doing so. When Tyndall returned to
England at the end ofthe season he*persuaded the Royal Society
to vote a grant ofmoney to Balmat in recognition of his services
to science. By that time Tyndall had made yet another ascent of
the mountain, during which he spent twenty hours on the
summit.
106
All these ascents could have been justified by Tyndall as
adjuncts to his scientific enquiries. Like Forbes he was investigat-
ing the glaciers. Like other scientists he was concerning himself
with the properties of air, of light, of sound, and he could claim
that many of his investigations demanded that observations be
made on high mountains.
Yet in 1860 Tyndall actually tried to climb the Matterhorn,
To realise just what this meant it is necessary to remember howAlbert Smith had been assailed for climbing Mont Blanc, a
mountain higher than the Matterhorn and therefore, according to
the current theory, far more worth while so far as scientists wereconcerned. If there were no new facts to be found on MontBlanc there were certainly none of scientific importance, at
least to be found on the Matterhorn. Yet Tyndall went at it
almost bull-headed, discarding much of his scientific shroud and
standing up, unashamedly, as one who wished to step beyondthat "cordon up to which one might go". What is more, he
succeeded in reaching a height of 13,000 ft., a height considerably
beyond that which men had yet reached on the mountain.
Tyndall, the scientist at the height of his energy and fame he
was just forty at the time was beginning to enjoy mountaineer-
ing for its own sake.
The following year he went to the Alps with one idea in his
mind, that of climbing the Weisshorn, then one of the "last
problems" of the Alps. He did so successfully, with Johann
Joseph Bennen, the enigmatic Valais guide who almost reluctantly
accompanied him on the great enterprise. From then onwards
Tyndall lived as a mountaineer in his own right, unsupported
by scientific necessities. He was already making climbs far
more difficult than those tackled by such men as Forbes or,
for that matter, by any man in mere search of scientific data.
He was moved by the spirit of combat and risk that the moun-tains offered him; from the position of a man who carefully
exploited the mountains for their scientific value, he had
marched in a few strides to the other end of the calendar.
There is a touch of the "death-or-glory" boys about some of
his exploits.
V.M. *107
I followed him while the stones flew thick and fast between us
[he says, of Bennen on the Old Weisthor in 1862]. Once an ugly
lump made right at me; I might, perhaps, have dodged it but Bennen
saw it coming, turned, caught it on the handle ofhis axe as a cricketer
catches a ball, and thus deflected it from me.
He was, we may surmise from his record, a man who was
titillated by danger, and across all his worthy, learned, and
essentially dull scientific record there is drawn the shadow of
another man, the man whom duty prevented him from being on
more than isolated occasions. He would, says an eye-witness,
delight picnic parties by hanging from his heels from the highest
trees to be found. In the Alps, where the little Marjelensee
bordered the great Aletsch Glacier, he would jump on to the
nearest miniature icebergs and balance on them until they finally
gave him the inevitable cold bath. On his stray visits to Cornwall
he would sometimes be found clambering with unexpectedinterest up some of those northern cliffs which have since
exercised the ingenuity of both the Climbers' Club and the
Commandos.
He was, parallel with his stern, calculating scientific exterior,
a genuine mountain adventurer, seeing in small rocks as well as in
great mountains the challenge of physical matter. At the heightof his scientific fame he was the only man other than Whymperwho believed that the Matterhorn would one day be climbed.
The frill story of his efforts to justify the belief can be pieced
together only from his Hours of Exercise in the Alps and from
Whymper's Scrambles. The two men clashed, as might have been
expected. Had either Tyndall or Whymper had less similar
mountain ambitions, they might have joined forces in the earlyi86o's as Whymper was later to join forces with Hudson and
have climbed the mountain before that fatal day in 1865 that
influenced all Alpine history.
As it was, Tyndall stood on the touch-lines of the Matterhorn
story, a position in which his actions are revealing of his im-
petuous, tenacious, yet analytic character. For it was Tyndall whoafter the accident of 1865 seriously suggested the fantastic scheme
of having himself lowered down tie Matterhorn precipices
108
by some 2,000 ft. of rope in an effort to find Lord Francis
Douglas' undiscovered body. And it was Tyndali who in 1868
made the first traverse and the seventh ascent of the Matterhorn,
climbing the mountain from Breuil, in Italy, and descending to
Zcrmatt in Switzerland.
Thus, he made few high Alpine ascents. Overwork, illness,
and marriage, all contributed. Yet so soon as he had the funds he
built, on the Lusgen Alp near the Bel Alp, the ugly Villa Lusgenfrom which he might look across the Rhone Valley to what he
considered was the most beautiful view in the Alps. He spentmuch of his time at Hindhead, where his house, the first to marthat lovely spot, still looks down the Happy Valley to the distant
gap in the South Downs where the nick of the highroad crosses
the last barrier to Portsmouth and the open sea. He loved high
pkces. He loved the beauty he found there, however disturbing
and unscientific might be the emotions which it aroused.
In all TyndalTs relations with mountains, other than those
which are astringently scientific, there is some feeling that he
gained from them an awareness of life and death that he would
otherwise have missed. He thought the danger worth while. Theywere, for him it seemed, an educator whose value was almost as
great as that of science. They enabled him to enjoy life more, to
put more into it and to take more out. Had he approved the
word, Tyndali might almost have claimed that the mountains
were a religion. For many Victorian scientists it appears that theywere a substitute for something which their own religion had
failed to give them.
109
Chapter Five
THE CLERGYIt is something to have wept as we have wept,
It is something to have done as we have done;
It is something to have watched, when all men slept,
And seen the stars which never see the sun;
It is something to have smelt the mystic rose,
Although it break and leave the thorny rods;
It is something to have hungered once as those
Must hunger who have ate the bread ofgods.
G. K. CHESTERTON
age in which the specialisedcraftsmen of the Alpine
JL Club worked out the details of their sport was something
more than an age of religious belief. It was an age in which all
religious belief was being challenged with a wealth of apparent
evidence that had not been seen for some considerable time.
There were questionings, and they involved the whole basis of
religioustruth on which many Victorian mountaineers had
founded their lives. They were the result not only ofthe onward
stumble ofscience in general, but of the growing knowledge that
illuminated one particular aspect ofscience.
This aspect was archaeology, or the story ofman's past. It was
just possible to consider the theories of the earth's creation eons
before the date laid down in the Bible and yet still keep a hold on
belief. The problem became altogether more difficult when the
discoveries in the Somme Valley, made by Boucher de Perthes
and confirmed by a reputable if unofficial British commission of
enquiry in 1859, placed the beginnings of man's history at least
some hundreds of millenia back.
Dr. Joan Evans, in Time and Chance, has well described the
impact which these discoveries had on the mind ofVictorian man.
no
The establishment of the existence of palaeolithic man [she says]
did more than add chapters to human history. It added vast stretches
oftime to those ages which even the most anthropocentric philosophermust consider; it destroyed the conventional chronology of Church
and University; it brought a new proportion into man's view ofthe
cosmos, that was only comparable with the change of proportion
brought about by the Renaissance discovery of a new world.
It is not to be wondered at that this attack on belief, uninten-
tional though it might be, should have had an equally disturbing
effect both on those who made it and on those at whose beliefs it
was directed. It was, after all, the Eternity ofthe scientists as well
as of the clergymen which was suddenly being lifted away from
their future.
It would be presumptuous to claim that many of the Victorian
clergymen who went mountaineering did so, even indirectly, to
reassure themselves about an after-life; or that the scientists did
so to prove to themselves that their revelations had not really
altered life. The thinkers of the period did not really climb
because they witnessed in the mountains some newly seen yetconstant physical phenomena in a changing world. The scientists
among them were only too well aware ofthe fallacy disguised bythe phrase "the everlasting hills". The clergy found that their
guides, those well-tried mountain friends, still believed in manymystic goings-on that had little to do with Christianity.
Yet the blunt truth is that many deeply religious men did find,
during their mountain excursions, some satisfying reinforcement
to their beliefs. The first and most obvious reason for this was
that many mountaineers, then as now, found their sense of God
heightened, illuminated, and justified by their physical experi-
ences in the mountains. Wills on the Wetterhorn, feeling "as in
the more immediate presence of Him who had reared this
tremendous pinnacle", was typical. So was Charles Hudson, whoafter John Birkbeck's escape on the Col de Miage he was onlynineteen when he slid some i ,800 ft. put down the escape to what
he called a "long chain ofprovidential arrangements due . . . surely
to Him who guides and protects us day by day". Whymperhimself, troubled with doubts throughout his lifetime, and even
in
at his most emotional hardly a religious man, reveals in the care-
folly self-edited Scrambles at least some shadow of that feeling
which crossed his mind when after the Matterhorn accident two
great crosses hung in the sky before the eyes of the horrified
survivors. The references to God and His near Presence, regular
as they are in the Alpine literature of the day, were not written
in by the pioneers as a matter of conventional form. They were
felt and experienced, and those feelings and experiences were
doubly deep because of the doubts which had, for a while, flitted
across the mind.
The problems created by the impinging of science on religious
thought lie at the nub of the matter. Without their impetus,
mountaineering would not have shot forward with such jet-
propelled speed during the second halfof the nineteenth century,
It was natural, therefore, that the clergy should play an important
part in its development. Many were not clergy as one would use
the word today. University regulations being what they were, it
was normal in many cases essential for those wishing to
prosper in an academic life to take Holy Orders. Some, such as
Hereford George, the first editor of the Alpine Journal, whodevoted his talents largely to military history and mountain-
climbing, never held even a curacy. Many, such as Coolidge,found that neither the taking ofHoly Orders nor the minor workof a small parish necessarily involved any thundering or militant
work of protestations. A few, like Leslie Stephen, resigned HolyOrders as their opinion ofthe world developed and as they steppedmore clearly out into it; others, such as George, were ordained
only when their feet were about to feel their way cautiously upthe ladder of success.
Yet even when such men are taken into account, it seems true
that the clergy illuminate better than any other single group, justwhat it was that drove men ofthe period up into the hills. For the
clergy, more obviously than most, did not climb to demonstrate
their physical courage or because they were not so good at
organised games. Many of them did, of course, revel in the
toughening and heroic business of climbing difficult mountains,
diluting it where necessary by the use ofsuitable guides. But they
112
might have taken equal risks in any of a dozen other dangerous
pursuits. They chose mountaineering for the simple reason that
it could, and did, provide something that no other pastime did
offer. What that almost indefinable quality really was, can best
be inferred from the fact that the serious thinkers appreciated it
most. For it was a moral quality. It was a satisfaction ofthe mind
rather than of the body. It was a window through which mansaw his own justification. It was something which in some in-
explicable way restored his dignity and confidence and belief in
life. It was something that reassured the clergy among whom so
many enthusiastic mountaineers of the period were counted.
Of the suggested members of the Alpine Club who replied
favourably to Kennedy's circular which he issued after the
"Leasowes" meeting, more than a quarter were clergymen. The
Rev. Hort was among them, of course, and so was the future
Canon Lightfoot. So was Hardy, Llewellyn Davies, and a
number of other clerics whose interest in the Club's activities
eventually waned. The first editor of the Alpine Journal was
George who was not, however, ordained until after the end of
his editorship; the second was Leslie Stephen who relinquished
Holy Orders three years after the end of his editorship. The
fourth was the Rev. W. A. B. Coolidge who took Holy Orders
while in office.
Hudson, killed on the Matterhorn, was the greatest amateur of
his age; Julius Elliott, who in Britain discovered the "ordinary"
way up the Pillar Rock and who in Switzerland was the first to
follow Whymper's fateful footsteps from Zermatt to the summit
of the Matterhorn; Girdlestone, who achieved either fame or
notoriety according to one's point of view for his advocacy of
guideless climbing; all these were typical of the clergymen whomade climbing their one major recreation. It is difficult to dis-
cover any aspect of Victorian climbing in which some cleric does
not play an important part.
Hudson and the two Smyths had been among the first of the
young men in Holy Orders who during the 1850'$ had helped to
create the sport of mountaineering. Yet however great their
mountain ability, they were religious flyweights and it was left to
Hort and Lightfoot, both of them among the leading Biblical
scholars ofthe day, to demonstrate the fact that profound religions
study mixed well with high Alpine travel.
Hort was the more important of the two in both the academic
and the mountaineering sense. He made his first, five-week, tour
in the Alps in 1854 at the age of twenty-six, and after only this
slight experience returned two years later with most ambitious
plans.
Lightfoot and I PIC wrote to the Rev. John Ellerton, one of his
oldest friends] have agreed to rendezvous at LuzernJuly ipth, spenda week in training among the peaks of Uri, etc., ending at the
Grimsel, and a fortnight in the snow regions ofthe Bernese Oberland
(the ascent of the Jungfrau and Finsteraarhorn being dreamed of);
and then make all haste to St. Gervais at the foot of Mt. Blanc,
where we expect to find Hawkins and perhaps Ames or Watson,
and thence ascend Mt. Blanc himself (this is a dead secret) by the
new route, thereby avoiding the extortions ofChamonix. Lightfoothas made not up his mind how much farther he will accompany us
before diverging to Germany, but at all events Hawkins and myselftalk of moving eastward, crossing and recrossing the main chain
till we reach Zermatt, and then spend some two or three weeks in
that region, going up Mt. Rosa and as many other of the highest
points (mostly unexplored hitherto) as we can manage, and then
return home. I hope we shall find it an expedition to be remembered.
As it turned out, he made the eighth ascent of theJungfrau and
was turned back by weather three times on the St. Gervais route
up Mont Blanc which had then been ascended only by Hudsonand Kennedy's party the previous year. It was on this visit to the
Alps that Hort first tried his hand at mountain photography,
carrying a bulky full-plate camera on many of his climbs but
failing to achieve results through waiting too long to develop his
plates. Many of the early climbers had done their imperfect best
to take Alpine photographs. Ruskin claims the credit for whathe calls "the first sun-portrait ever taken of the Matterhorn andas far as I know ofany Swiss mountain whatever", in 1849. Thetwo Smyths carried about a photographic tent for use on their
climbs in the mid-fifties, and G. Joad, who accompanied Hudson
114
and Kennedy for part of their guideless ascent of Mont Blanc
in 1855, took a number of photographs, one of which was used
as the basis for the frontispiece of Where There $ a Will There's a
Way. And there was the unnamed English colonel whomMrs. Cole met in the Val Anzasca in 1858, complete with wife,
developing tent, and mule for carrying the photographic equip-ment. Bisson, the Frenchman, made three photographic journeysto the summit of Mont Blanc in 1861, 1862, and 1863, spendingfive days at the Grands Mulets on his second trip. Yet it was not
until Hereford Brooke George made his family tour of the Ober-
land in 1865, taking with him Ernest Edwardes, a portrait photo-
grapher of some standing, that good results above the snowline
were achieved by any British mountaineer.
George, more than most of the climbers, "looked the part".
With red beard and great height, he was massive and confident
both ofmind and of body, with a record both on the mountains
and in the sphere of Alpine organisation quite equal to the
reputation he later acquired as an historian.
He first visited Switzerland at the age of twenty-two and was
taken on a minor glacier expedition by Leslie Stephen. Hereturned the following year, crossed the Monchjoch and climbed
Mont Blanc. And he then, having joined the Alpine Club, threw
himself with tremendous fervour into the conquest of the Alps*
unclimbed peaks and uncrossed passes. The following year he
became the editor of the newly founded AlpineJournal. He served
on a special committee which was set up by the Alpine Club to
lay down standards for ropes, axes, and alpenstocks, and he
devoted what leisure he had not only to the major problems of
Alpine travel but also to the most minor details of equipment. In
1865 he planned and led the ambitious tour through the Oberland
made by three ladies and six men, and organised largely with an
eye on the photographic possibilities. And, in between the minor
excursions made for the benefit of the photographer and of the
ladies, he took part in a number of major climbs, including the
first ascent of the Jungfiau from the Wengern Alp and the first
ascent of the Gross-Nesthorn. Soon afterwards, in the iSyo's, he
founded the Oxford Alpine Club.
Mountains and mountaineering had captured George's interest
and imagination. And, with a fullness that was alien to most of
his fellows, George explained carefully just why this was so. The
attraction was, he infers, a complex one, half-Jingoist, half--
ethereal.
The climbing spirit [he wrote], like the love ofall kindred pursuits,
is essentially a form of that restless energy, that love of action for its
own sake, of exploring the earth and subduing it, which has made
England the great coloniser of the world, and has led individual
Englishmen to penetrate the wildest recesses of every Continent.
Yet this was not the only explanation from the young man whowas to take Holy Orders two years later.
The deeper we penetrate into the arcana ofnature, so as to discern
"the law within the law", the more clearly do we perceive that above
and beyond all law rises the supreme will of the Almighty lawgiver
[he wrote]. Familiarity with the wonders of the Alps is among the
best means of originating and deepening such impressions; for their
gigantic size and awful phenomena tend to produce an effect not
merely on our intellectual perceptions, but also upon the moral
feelings.
George, who was about to enter the Church, had, in fact, dis-
covered in the Alps some revelation curiously similar to that
found by Stephen who after taking Holy Orders changed his
views, ceased to regard himself as a clergyman, and profoundlydisturbed many of his friends by his An Agnostics Apology. The
mountains, to Stephen:
represent the indomitable force of nature to which we are forced
to adapt ourselves; they speak to man of his littleness and his
ephemeral existence; they rouse us from the placid content in whichwe may be lapped when contemplating the fat fields which we have
conquered and the rivers which we have forced to run according to
our notions ofconvenience. And, therefore, they should suggest not
sheer misanthropy, as they did to Byron, or an outburst of revolu-
tionary passions, as they did to his teacher Rousseau, but that sense
ofawe-struck humility which befits such petty creatures as ourselves.
Both George and Stephen had been educated, in the Alps, into
116
17, 1 8 On the Mer de Glace in the late iSyo's
As-M-fc^^i^^^ *" ' .V . "mJ'J '* *, *.
*'
19 Sir Edward Davidson and his Guides
their own particular brand of humility; they both felt rather like
Frederic Harrison's man who needed "sometimes to know
nothing and to feel nothing, but that he is a marvellous atom in a
marvellous world".
Stephen stands at the heart of the attraction which mountain-
eering had for the religiously inclined of the mid-Victorian years,
just as that attraction lies at the root of its meteoric expansionbetween 1850 and 1880. A clergyman turned agnostic, Stephenwas yet a deeply religious man throughout his whole life. Dis-
turbed as he was by Darwin in a way that Hort never was ("In
spite of difficulties, I am inclined to think it unanswerable",
wrote Hort, who kept his belief. "In any case, it is a treat to read
such a book"), Stephen appears to have created, from his experi-ences in the mountains, a new belief for the one he had rejected.
He was ordained in 1855, at the age of twenty-three, and the
same year made his first visit to die Alps, a rambling-cum-
scrambling holiday in Bavaria. Two years later he spent a monthin the Mont Blanc area, and ascended the Col du Geant.
It was not until the following year that the mountains began to
influence him, that he met Kennedy, Hardy, and Hinchliff at
Zurich, and embarked on his meteoric Alpine career. By this
time he had been subjected to two influences. He had come under
the spell of the Alps themselves, "woven in a great degree by the
eloquence of Modern Painters"; and he had, as he also admitted,
been infected with the Alpine fever by reading Wills' Wanderings.
From the start of his climbing career he was therefore deeplyinfluenced by two diametrically opposed theories of Alpine
appreciation. The result was of considerable significance to the
Alpine world, for it made Stephen unique in at least one respect.
He could sup in full measure off the most glorious sights that the
mountains could offer, and could explain their beauties to others;
yet he could also gain equal joy from setting out on expeditions
that were invariably difficult, frequently dangerous and, judged
by the standards of the Ruskinians, completely useless.
The 1858 campaign was a six-week tour during which Stephenfirst met Melchior Anderegg, his guide and lifelong friend, and
during which he made a number of high ascents, including that
V.M. 7 119
of Monte Rosa. The great years commenced in 1859,
eight seasons Stephen strode up and across the Alps, taking part
in a score offirst ascents any one ofwhich would have placed him
among the most accomplished mountaineers of the day. The
first ascent of the Schreckhorn and ofMonte Delia Disgrazia, the
first complete ascent of Mont Blanc from St. Gervais, the first
passage of the Jungfraujoch and of the Viescherjoch these are
only a few of the great courses he accomplished in an almost
casual manner during the early i86o's.
He was a vigorous, forty-mile-a~day man who covered the
country "like compasses over a small-scale map", and who was
always proud to have walked the fifty miles from Cambridge to
London in twelve hours to attend an Alpine Club dinner. He was
the dominating personality in the Alpine Dining Club, whose
crest was described by Moore. He was occupied like most of his
contemporaries, in a score ofdifferentjobs from electioneering to
writing, from organising University clubs to pamphleteering; and
he was, throughout the whole of his early Alpine career, cogita-
ting on his religious commitments. The doubts had begun in
1862 when he had first refused to take part in Chapel services.
Finally, in 1875, he relinquished Holy Orders and began writingthe long series ofessays later collected as An Agnostic's Apology.Yet Stephen's retreat from Christianity was unlike that ofmany
others. "In truth," he later wrote, "I did not feel that the solid
ground was giving way beneath my feet, but rather that I was
being relieved of a cumbrous burden." More curiously, his
personal actions continued almost exactly along those broad lines
of conduct that are followed by most Christians. During the
years that he first spent in the mountains he ceased to believe, he
felt, in any form of God. Reading today what Stephen wrote
three-quarters of a century ago, it is difficult not to believe that
what happened was the transmutation of his beliefs into some-
thing different, something non-Christian, but something that
hardly warrants the word agnosticism.There followed, after his change of heart and his marriage,
both of which took place in the late sixties, another eight years
during which his activities in the mountains were limited by the
120
fears ofhis wife. He made the first ascent of the Cima di Ball, and
ofMont Mallet "that child ofmy old age" as he called it and
the first passage of the Col des Hirondelles; yet by far the greater
part of his holidays were taken up with excursions of minor
importance; and, after the death of his wife it was to the newly
developing sport of winter mountaineering rather than to moreorthodox climbing that he devoted himself.
President of the Alpine Club, editor of the Alpine Journal,
Stephen spread his influence over the mountain world not only
by his energy, not only by the force of his personality and the
doughtiness of his deeds, but also by his ability to write. The
Playground ofEurope, his book which was published in 1871 and
told of his most famous ascents, was not merely the best-written
book of Alpine climbing that had been published. It had one
quality which all the others, with the exception of Whymper'sScrambles, notably lacked. It explained an attitude to life. It was,
in the literal sense, literature, which the Oxford Dictionary defines
as "writings esteemed for beauty of form or emotional effect".
It had not only a lasting influence but a finish beside which almost
all other Alpine books that men could then buy had the polish
of a crusty loaf.
Stephen did not climb on into old age. Work overtook him
like night falling on a traveller hurrying for home. Yet until the
last he retained an affection for all the memories that were
summoned up by the two old ice-axes he gave to the Alpine Club
a few months before his death. "Those quaint old poles", he
wrote to Lord Conway, on whose shoulders was felling some-
thing of Stephen's mantle at the turn of the century, "reminded
me of some of the pleasantest days ofmy life."
121
Chapter Six
WHYMPER, THE MAN WITHTHE CHIP ON HIS SHOULDER
Sooner or late in earnest or in jest
(But the stakes are no jest) Ithuriel's Hour
Will spring on us, for the first time, the test
Ofour sole unbacked competence and power
Up to the limit ofour years and dower
OfJudgment or beyond. But here we have
Prepared long since our garland or our grave
For, at that hour, the sum of all our past,
Act, habit, thought and passion, shall he cast
In one addition, be it more or less,
And as that reading runs so shall we do;
Meeting, astounded, victory at the last,
Or, first and last, our own unworthiness.
And none can change us though they die to save!
RUDYARD KIPLING
AS the stately if somewhat ponderous procession of Victorian
JLJL. mountaineers gathered numbers there suddenly burst uponit the young, enthusiastic, and slightly brash figure who was to
provide its climax, was to cast over it a rather sultry shadow of
doom, and who was to remain, for nearly a century, one ofthe most written-about, if not the most controversial, figureof the whole astonishing group.
His name was Edward Whymper. He was an artist-engraver,a man who had learned the business in his father's Lambeth worksand who, judged by the standards of those who formed the bulkof Alpine Club members, might almost have been dismissed bythe one word "trade". It was not that there existed, as such, anydistinction of class or money; it was merely that few men of the
122
trading layer of society had the opportunity for making high
Alpine ascents.
Whymper's "trade", however, was the direct reason for his
first visit to the Alps and, indirectly, for the speed with which he
rocketed into the most distinguished parts of the Alpine firma-
ment. At the age of twenty, before setting out for a long tour on
behalfofhis father's business, he was asked by William Longmanto prepare a series of sketches for the coming volume of Peaks,
Passes and Glaciers which was then in course of preparation. ThePelvoux in the Dauphine, it was added, was one of those moun-tains which it was especially desired to illustrate in the volume.
The young Whymper, whose imagination had earlier been
aroused by the search for Franklin which had stirred the mid-
1850*5, had long nourished an ambition for Arctic travel Here,
he well reasoned, was the chance for serving at least a near-
apprenticeship; in the snow and ice regions of the Alps he mightlearn something of the problems he would have to overcome.
He gladly accepted Longman's commission.
The story ofwhat happened during the following five years is
among the most famous of all adventure stories. How the youngman made his first Alpine tour almost as a business trip; how some
attraction drew him back the following year when he made his
first attempt to climb the unclimbed Matterhom the mountain
whose remarkable form he had not even noted when he had first
walked up the valley to Zermatt; how attempt followed attempt
until, in 1865, he finally climbed the peak; and how, after the
moment of triumph, day was turned into night by the disaster
which killed four of the seven members of the party all these
events have become something more than the facts in a story
which has moved thousands ofmen and women who have never
climbed a mountain and never wished to do so. They have
become more than the climax of the Golden Age ofmountaineer-
ing. They have become, in some subtle way, the epitome of all
mountain-climbing; a moral to those who would argue against
the pastime and an inspiration to those who maintain that it leads
men not only to higher but also to better things. They have
formed the subject of films, of radio plays, books, and a whole
V.M. 7* 123
wealth of learned papers debating the minutiae of the case, the
attraction of which would remain even were there not, to this
day, a lingering suspicion; a suspicion that all has not even yet
been told about the events of that fateful day in 1865 when the
"sharp-eyed lad ran into the Monte Rosa Hotel saying that he
had seen an avalanche on the Matterhorn" an awful avalanche
whose import only those on the mountain then knew.
There are two reasons for this enduring interest in Whymperand the main event of his life. One lies in the story ofthe Matter-
horn itself, the second in the character of its conqueror.
Whymper climbed for none of the mixed moral reasons that
moved his contemporaries. He saw mountains clearly and with-
out qualification as a challenge to man's supremacy. He climbed,
it must be admitted, for a reason entirely the reverse of those
which affected most of the men who formed the Alpine Club.
It must be wondered whether he ever understood any of
them.
Whymper makes icily clear in the fourth chapter of the
Scrambles just what it was that attracted him to the Matterhorn.
The mountain had not been climbed; neither had the Weisshorn,
and it isjust those two peaks which excited his imagination. Whenhe heard rumours that the Weisshorn had been climbed his
interest in it abated. So far as he was concerned, and whatever
else he might put into his mountain training, it was then only the
Matterhorn that was really important. This single-mindednessis underlined in a letter which Hort wrote to his wife from
Switzerland on August i, 1865. He had been in touch with
Girdlestone, who had himself been with Whymper only a few
days before the accident, and Hort says of Whymper: "He was
resolved to do the Matterhorn, and equally resolved, when that
was done, to give up mountaineering, because there were nomore new great mountains to be conquered."
Whymper had to climb the Matterhorn not when he first saw
it, for the sheer wonder ofits form appears to have passed him by,but when he first appreciated that his long limbs, stamina, and
energy enabled him to climb and climb well. Here, in this large
lump of stone was an object that had so far defied the progress
124
of the age in which he lived; as a matter of duty it had to be
conquered.The attitude was hardly a happy one and from the moment of
decision the tragedy of Whymper's story somehow appearsinevitable. It is true that on the bare facts as told by Whympcrthere seemed nothing inevitable about it. He might never have
succeeded in climbing the mountain. There might never have
been the plans of a party of Italians, plans which matured in the
summer of 1865 so that they were trying to climb the mountain,
with Carrel, Whymper's former guide, while his party was on
the mountain. A dozen events might have intervened but, read-
ing the Scrambles, one cannot feel that they were likely. Events
marched steadily forward as Whymper's experience increased,
and as he made his second, third, fourth, fifth, sixth, and seventh
attempts to climb the mountain. When it might have been
ascended by other parties and Tyndall's was one that nearly did
so Fate steps in with upraised hand; she brings the Italian
expedition to Breuil at the right moment, gives Whymper time
to hurry across the Theodule Pass, brings up Hadow, Hudson,
and Lord Francis Douglas, and sets the stage for the final scene.
It is this sense of inevitable doom, spreading over a whole life
from the moment that Whymper decides that the mountain shall
be his and his alone, as much as the story of the accident itself,
which gives a certain tragic dignity to Whymper's story.
This is heightened by the fact that Whymper's philosophy,
which drove him up and on to the mountain, did not quite stand
up to the accident. Many men who had sought some mystic
revelation in the mountains continued, not only to climb but to
preach the value of the hills, even after friends and relatives had
perished. Whymper, who climbed to prove man's supremacy, not
only gave up high climbing after the accident as he had, in any
case, planned to do but looked at the world through different
eyes. For him there was "never glad confident morning again".
The accident formed a watershed in Whymper's life. It formed
a dividing line, marking a deep contrast not only in the things that
he did but also in the kind ofman into which he was developing;
twenty-five was a young age at which to have crossed it.
125
Until that day in 1865 everything had gone relatively well with
him. The Matterhorn had been the only major mountain on
which he had teen repeatedly repulsed. His reputation had grownseason by season, and it must have seemed that in spite of his
background, in spite of the fact that he had an approach to
climbing very different from that of his contemporaries, in spite
of his naturally dour and unfriendly nature, the place he was to
take in the select Alpine circle would be an important one. It
was, in fact, destined to be unique. After the accident a cloud
seemed to hang over everything that he did. It is true that he
became a member of the Alpine Club Committee for two years.
After the publication of the Scrambles he was Vice-President. Hewent to the Andes, and he achieved one of his early ambitions by
visiting Greenland. Yet nothing except the business of earning a
living appears to have moved him as climbing moved himbetween the ages of twenty and twenty-five. It may be, as Hort
suggested, that the passion died when"there were no more new
great mountains to be conquered". It is certain that the first fine
careless rapture had not been transmuted into the calmer but more
abiding emotion which lights the middle and later life of so manymountaineers; instead, alljoy had gone from the business and life
was darker and more empty because of it.
Whymper's first tour ofthe Alps was a seven-week affair whichin 1860 took him to the Oberland, to Zermatt, and to Chamonix.He made a number ofminor ascents, crossed a number of passes,
some of them alone, and, as he said, acquired the passion for
mountain-scrambling. He was agile, active, audacious, and
impatient of all authority. It was typical that when he arrived at
Chamonix and found the Mer de Glace closed to tourists for the
visit of the Emperor Napoleon, he should have scrambled abovethe glacier, outwitted the guards, and arrived at the Montanvertas the Imperial party was leaving. The same afternoon, he adds,he failed to get to the Jardin, and very nearly succeeded in break-
ing a leg.
The next year he went back to the Alps with one main aim, to
126
climb Mont Pelvoux which had been unsuccessfully attemptedthe previous year by Bonney and his party. As usual, Whympersucceeded. He met Reginald Macdonald, a young clerk in the
Colonial Office, made with him the first ascent of the peak and
then, after ten days' wandering, crossed the Mont Cenis, where
the great tunnel was in course of construction, and made his first
attempt on the Matterhorn.
It was on this occasion that he had his first meeting with Jean-Antoine Carrel, the Italian guide who regarded the Matterhorn
as his own domain, and whose ambition it was to make the ascent
from Italy for the honour of his native valley.
By 1861 there had been more than one attempt on the Matter-
horn; the majority ofmountaineers still considered that it was not
only inaccessible but that it would remain so. Carrel himselfhad
made tentative attempts with other men from his little village of
Breuil, below the southern slopes of the Matterhorn, and had
eventually reached the "Chimney", a prominent feature 12,650 ft.
up the mountain, and 2,132 ft. below the summit. In 1860, the
three Parker brothers, Liverpool business men whose promise of
meteoric Alpine careers came to little, tackled the Matterhorn
without guides from Zermatt, following, so far as they went,
roughly the route by which the mountain was eventually climbed
five years later. Francis Vaughan Hawkins, a barrister who had
been climbing since the mid-i85O*s, had reconnoitred the
Matterhorn in 1859 with Bennen, a guide from the Valais, and
one of the few other than Carrel who believed that the mountain
would one day be climbed. In 1860 Bennen, together with Jean-
Jacques Carrel uncle ofJean-Antoine and Professor Tyndall,
had climbed some 300 ft. beyond the "Chimney". In 1861, the
Parkers had renewed their attempts from the Zermatt side, but
had climbed only slightly beyond the point they had reached the
previous year.
This was the position when Whymper arrived at Breuil with
an unnamed guide and negotiated for die services of Carrel, "the
cock ofthe valley", the "well-made resolute-looking fellow with
a certain defiant air". Sparks flew, Whymper attacked the
mountain with his inexperienced guide but without Carrel, and
127
from the evening light of a bivouac watched two figures creep
past Carrel and his uncle stealing a march on the foreigners and
trying to ensure that the first ascent should be made not only
from the Italian side but also by Italians. It was possibly from that
moment that the scales tipped over, that what had been a desire
to be first on the summit of the Matterhorn became an almost
pathological obsession with Whymper.On this occasion Whymper was turned back below the "Chim-
ney". Carrel climbed higher, up to that spot where he had
previously used the iron spike of his axe to cut in the living rock
the date, a cross, his initials, and the rough design ofa tiara.
Whymper returned to England, the idea of Alpine conquest as
deeply engraved on his mind as Carrel's cross had been cut into
the rock of the Matterhorn. He was elected a member of the
Alpine Club. He brooded over his defeat on the mountain, and
the following season he returned to Switzerland earlier than
before, during the first days of July. He made his second and
third attempts on the Matterhorn, both with Macdonald, went
up Monte Rosa, and then made his fourth attempt on the Matter-
horn an attempt made alone, and one during which he climbed
past the points reached by earlier explorers, to a height of about
1 3 ,400 ft. During the descent he sustained the dramatic fall which
is the subject of a famous illustration in the Scrambles, an illus-
tration whose suggestion of a near-vertical drop of 200 ft. has a
bearing on a later dispute about another illustration in the book.
He made a fifth attempt on the mountain the same year and was
only prevented from making yet another by the cantankerous
argument which broke out between himself and Professor
Tyndall.
The following year, 1863, Whymper again visited his old battle-
field in the Pennines, attempted the Dent d'H6rens, completed a
circuit of the Matterhorn, ascended the Grand Tournalin bymaking the first ascent of the North-West arete, and then carried
out the sixth attempt on the Matterhorn, an attempt which washalted by bad weather.
It was on this occasion that Wilberforce, the Bishop of Oxford,was speaking to a number of Englishmen in the dining-room of
128
the Hotel Mont Cervin in Zermatt, and referred to the Matter-
horn as still unclimbed.
We all [said one who was there] knew that Whymper was, that
very day, making one of his attempts upon the mountain, and I amafraid that bets were freely offered and taken as to whether the
Bishop was correct.
"Whymper had achieved something of a reputation by this
time. He was relentless in his assault on rocks, he used everydevice which his ingenuity could invent, and he had none of the
dislike which existed even then for artificial aids. He designed his
own form ofgrappling iron which could be slung high above the
climber in the hope that it might gain a grip on some rock or
protuberance above a difficult spot perhaps the genuine pre-
cursor of a delicate climb known as "Rope-Wall" on the Mile-
stone Buttress of Tryfaen in North Wales. He devised the
Whymper Tent. He would bar no artifice in his single-mindedintention of getting to the top of whatever mountain he chose to
attack.
He was, therefore, more than adequately equipped when he
set out for his great tour ofthe Dauphine in 1864, a tour in whose
tracks many mountaineers have followed with admiration not
unmixed with wonder. With Moore and Horace Walker he left
St. Michel in the Arc Valley, and between the middle and end of
June made an elaborate series of magnificent first ascents and
passages. The first crossing of the Col des Aiguilles d'Arves, the
first ascent of the south peak ofthe Aiguilles de la Sausse, the first
passage of the Breche de la Meije by which a passage was forced
from La Grave on the Route Napoleon to La Berarde, the remote
little village lying in the heart of the Dauphine, the first ascent of
the Ecrins, the highest peak in the area, and the first passage ofthe
Col de la Pilatte, were the principal incidents in the amazing
fortnight.
All these were expeditions which had excited the interest of
more experienced, of older, and of more mature mountaineers.
Whymper's party contained, it is true, experienced men in the
persons ofMoore and Walker; it was led by Croz and Christian
129
Aimer, two ofthe greatest guides then alive. Yet it is difficult not
to believe that the driving force came largely from Whymper,One can see him demanding just that little extra effort; urging,
cajoling, ordering, being as ill-tempered as the occasion might
demand, and finally getting his own way when the others mighthave let the sport take its own course.
From the Dauphine, Whymper went to Chamonix, and with
Moore and Adams-Reilly continued to add to his collection of
"firsts" Mont Dolent, the Aiguille de Trelatete, and the Aiguille
d'Argenti&re, as well as the first passages ofthe Col de Triolet and
the Morning Pass.
The following fateful year began in the same way, with first
ascents notably of the Grand Cornier and the Aiguille Verte
and success sprouting from almost every venture that Whympertouched. Then, on July 12, he arrived at Zermatt with Lord
Francis Douglas, a climber of some mountaineering, and con-
siderable athletic, reputation whom he had met near Breuil.
At Zermatt they encountered Hudson, who was accompanied byMichel Croz and a young man named Hadow whom Hudson
was escorting on his first visit to the Alps. Whymper knew that
Carrel, his former guide, was about to lead an Italian party in an
attempt to reach the summit of the Matterhorn from the Italian
side. Almost on the spur ofthe moment, it seems, Whymper and
Lord Francis Douglas linked parties with Hudson and Hadowand decided to make a combined attack on the mountain from
Zermatt. On the morning of Thursday the thirteenth, the partyset out for the mountain Whymper, Hudson, Lord Francis
Douglas, and Hadow; with, as guides, Croz and "old" Peter
Taugwalder; and, as porters, Taugwalder's two sons, one ofwhomfinally stayed with the party until the summit was reached.
The story of the Matterhorn accident has been told and re-told
in extensive detail, and it is only necessary to recapitulate the bare
bones of the matter. Arrived on the summit without havingencountered any of the major difficulties which had been feared
the party of four amateurs and three guides saw the Italian
party many hundreds of feet below, on the southern, Italian,
slopes of the mountain. The British party shouted down, waved
130
to the Italians, and even prized out loose boulders which went
crashing down the steep face, in an effort to ensure that those
below should know of their defeat. There followed an hour of
lazing on the summit, of seeing the old peaks from a new and
triumphant angle, what Whymper himself has described as "one
crowded hour of glorious life".
Whymper and his party moved offfrom the summit with Croz
leading. Behind Croz came the young Hadow, already deeplyexhausted by the climb; Hudson; Lord Francis Douglas, and then
the elder Taugwalder. Whymper, and "young" Peter Taug-walder who was to be last man on the rope, remained on the
summit for a few minutes longer than their companions, then
roped together with Whymper in front. Some way below the
summit the twojoined themselves on to the already lengthy ropeof five men.
A few hundred feet down they reached the steepest part of
their route. The slabs were dangerous but not inherently difficult,
although in the circumstances they must have been difficult
enough. At one point, Croz turned to guide Hadow's feet into
the best positions on the rocks. Hadow appears to have slipped
although this is still only surmise and to have knocked Croz
from the position where he was standing firm. Their combined
weight pulled Hudson from the rocks, and the combined weightofthe three men pulled offLord Francis Douglas.
Immediately we heard Croz's exclamation, old Peter, and I
planted ourselves as firmly as the rocks would permit [says
Whymper in the Scrambles] . The rope was taut between us, and tie
jerk came on us both as on one man. We held; but the rope broke
mid-way between Taugwalder and Lord Francis Douglas. For a
few seconds we saw our unfortunate companions sliding downwards
on their backs, and spreading out their hands, endeavouring to save
themselves. They passed from our sight uninjured, disappearing one
by one, and fell from precipice to precipice on to the Matterhorn-
gletscher below, a distance ofnearly 4,000 feet in height. From the
moment the rope broke, it was impossible to help them.
So perished our comrades.
This was the disaster whose news swept across Europe and
whose impact was, in the words ofCaptain Farrar, to set back the
sport of mountaineering by a whole generation of men.
There are many factors which combined to give the Matter-
horn accident and which still combine to give it a uniqueinterest and fascination. The first, ofcourse, was the way in which
events had, almost inevitably it appears in retrospect, built them-
selves up to the tragic climax. Secondly and in some ways even
more important, there were the circumstances of the four menwho fell to their deaths; they were no ordinary travellers. Charles
Hudson was known in the small circle of climbers as possibly the
finest amateur of his time; Croz was one of the greatest guides;
Hadow, even at the age of nineteen, was acquiring a reputation
for athletic endurance even though he had virtually no mountain
background; Lord Francis Douglas, young but already experi-
enced, was a man who had a golden future opening out before
him while to the Continent at least he represented the dyingtradition of the English milord. There were the international
repercussions aroused by the obvious rivalry between the British
and the Italian parties. And there were the persistent rumours
frequently scandalous and invariably ill-informed thatWhymperwas not telling all that he might have told about the early stages
of the fateful descent. Any one of these things might have
turned the Matterhorn accident into a talking-point; together,
they turned it into the talking-point on which any argument
against the practice of mountain-climbing might convenientlybe hung.
In addition, there were some interesting technical details of the
ascent and the descent. It was an unusual if not unique practicefor seven men to be climbing on one rope on a mountain of this
difficulty; the inclusion in the party of Hadow was a matter for
which Hudson has been criticised more than once; there was the
peculiar but easily explainable coincidence that three different
types and qualities of ropes were used to link the party together.All these facts combined to make the Matterhorn accident a
matter over which climbing men might argue interminably, an
endless puzzle of theories and formulae and speculations in whichthere was enough technical information available to keep the
132
debate within reasonable bounds yet going for ever. Ofmore general importance was the outcry which the accident
aroused.
Newspapers in every country in Europe commented upon the
accident in their feature or their leader columns, The Times
pontifically asking of mountain-climbing in general: "But is it
life? Is it duty? Is it common sense?'*
Whymper himself, automatically held at Zermatt until the
Government enquiry on the accident had been held, regarded the
outcry with a contemptuous disdain that is readily understand-
able. He had given a short account of the affair to the English
chaplain at Zermatt who, with Whymper's approval, informed
The Times. Nothing more, felt Whymper, was really needed of
him, although he agreed that he would give a private report of
the affair to the Alpine Club. He left Zermatt for Interlaken, was
persuaded there to prepare an account of the accident for use bythe Swiss and Italian Alpine Clubs, and then returned to England.It was only after he had returned home, and learned of the
sensation that the accident had caused, that he finally wrote a
fuller account for The Times. That account, dated August 7, from
his home at Haslemere, was substantially the same as that con-
tained in the Scrambles, which was published six years later.
It is now generally accepted that the full story of the Matter-
horn disaster has been pieced together with the possible exception
of minor and unimportant details. Yet it seems clear that for
some reason possibly the wish to shield one of the six other
members of the party Whymper did not readily reveal all the
details of the accident.
Bishop Browne, a Fellow and Lecturer at St. Catherine's
College, Cambridge in 1865, was visited by Whymper on his
return to England immediately after the accident.
As Whymper had got into the way of consulting me about matters
other than Alpine [he wrote later], I was the first person to whomhe gave a full account ofwhat really took place. He came to see mein Cambridge. He had sealed up the bag in which he had the remains
of the rope. He came to consult me on two questions of casuistry,
on at least one of which he did not take my advice.
133
It might at first be thought that the reference is merely to minor
matters, possibly those elucidated when Captain Farrar succeeded
in obtaining publication of the evidence given at the Court of
Enquiry held in Zermatt after the accident.
However, some years after the publication of these proceedings
Lord Conway of Allington, then the Grand Old Man of climb-
ing, added a footnote to Browne and threw more light on the
queer question of the rope. "The late Dr. G. F. Browne, once
Bishop ofBristol, who in his turn became President ofthe Alpine
Club, told me not many years ago that he was the only living manwho knew the truth about the accident and that the knowledgewould perish with him, as it has perished/' Then he comes to
the rope.
It happened Pie says] that Whymper was the last man in the
party and could not actually see Hadow's slip and Croz' overthrow
by him, but two or three strands of the rope might have been
severed beforehand without anyone knowing. The end of the ropewould have retained some sign of the cutting. The end engravedin Scrambles is not the one where the breakage occurred. It is the
right rope but not the broken end.
Whymper did, in fact, seek more than one adviser when he
returned to England in 1865. Oscar Browning says that he went
straight to John Cowell, the Secretary of the Alpine Club, and
told him the story. "I was in London that day, and Cowell
repeated the story to me. The next morning Whymper's narra-
tive appeared in The Times, omitting some things which he had
told to Cowell."
These "things omitted" may have been the threats which
Whymper alleged in the Scrambles, though not in The Times'
letter had been made to him by the Taugwalders on the latter
part of the descent. They may have been merely minor details
of interest to mountaineers but of no significance to the general
story of the Matterhorn accident.
Whatever the truth, the Matterhorn accident flung its shadowacross the Victorian scene as no other had done. The prophets ofdisaster appeared to have been justified, as was Ruskin who knewthe Alpine glory entirely from below. All the Year Round, then
134
20 As a Man of 25
21 In his Middle Fifties
edited by Charles Dickens spoke through Dickens' mouth, it
seems certain of the
society for the scaling of such heights as the Schreckhorn, the Eiger,and the Matterhorn [which] contributed about as much to theadvancement of science as would a club of young gentlemen whoshould undertake to bestride all the weathercocks of all the cathedral
spires of the United Kingdom.
The mountaineers themselves, so shocked were they by the
tragedy, so much did four lives then mean, suffered glumly and
largely in silence, knowing that they were right in their ownattitude to climbing, but knowing also that the accident had giventhe rest ofthe world a stick with which to beat them.
Whymper himself exhibited little emotion, swung his interests
from mountain-climbing to the more scientific investigation ofthe Alps, and set steadily to work on the laborious task ofwriting,rewriting, and rewriting yet again, the one great book of his
life which was to give him an immortality even more sure thanthat gained by his ascent of the Matterhorn.
In the year following the accident he returned to the Alps to
investigate the theory and structure ofglaciers. In 1867 he
achieved his ambition of exploring Greenland. In 1869 herevisited the Alps, but did little more than cross the Col duLautaret and revisit the Mont Cenis tunnel, through which, two
years later, he made a journey on the first train to traverse the
line.
Throughout these years there had been persistent rumours that
Whymper's book was about to appear but, as The Times waslater to say of his volume on the Andes, finally published twelve
years after his travels through them, the author seemed to take a
grim delight in disappointing the public.At last, in 1871, there appeared Whymper's Scrambles amongst
the Alps in the Years 1860-1869. It was an astonishing book, a
mixture of naive amateur writing and inspired phrases, of first-
class descriptive reporting and dull slabs that might have beeninserted as examples ofwhat to avoid, of scientific comments and
purple patches. It was an astonishing book because, in spite of its
technical failings, it was a real book in which a man revealed
V.M. -8 137
himself; a book, moreover, in which one can still hear the thunder
of the falling rocks, and whose power is as strong as it was four-
fifths of a century ago.
The Scrambles was first produced by Murray at the round
Victorian sum of a guinea, and its second edition appeared two
years later. A third, slightly abridged, came out in 1879; a fourth
in 1893, and a fifth in 1900. A shilling edition with photographs
instead of the original illustrations appeared in the blue-bound
Nelson library in 1908. And in 1936 there carne the new edition
from Murray, with photographs, maps, and appendices that
included for the first time for popular reading the results of the
Zermatt inquest on the accident. The book was translated into
French and German, and pirated in other languages from one end
of the Continent to the other. It held and retained the affection
not only of most mountaineers but of whole generations of
potential climbers. Lord Schuster, whose mountain prose, almost
alone, can compare with Stephen's, is one of the hundreds whohave acknowledged their debt to Whymper for first havingaroused their interest in the mountains. The late Frank Smytheis another.
The peculiar fascination of the book does not lie only in the
story that it tells. It has an honest artlessness that summons up the
picture of Whymper, the man, in a way that few photographscan ever hope to do. It is true that Whymper wrote and rewrote
every line innumerable times; it is true that he wrote fresh
chapters in some of the later editions and excised some of bis
earlier material; it is true that he was for ever altering and amend-
ing and correcting, and that late in life he admitted to Coolidgethat the book still contained many mistakes. Yet in spite of all
these things the book yet remained one man's record of the
influence that mountains had had on him. For a whole segmentof the only partially informed public, Whymper was mountain-
eering for the rest ofhis life.
The Scrambles consolidated Whymper's position as a national
figure. He might not be the typical mountaineer; he might not
even be a normal one; yet for thousands ofmen and women this
stern-lipped sombre young man of few words was the survivor
138
of the Matterhorn. Whymper had at last found his lonely niche
in life. He cultivated the solitude of the position, and there is
little reason to believe that he would have been any happier had
his relations with his fellow men been more frequent, more
normal, or more friendly.
He did not entirely give up mountaineering. In 1872, he made
a solitary and rather rambling visit to Greenland. He went back
to the Matterhorn again and made the seventy-sixth ascent of the
peak with his old friendJean-Antoine Carrel as guide. Two years
later he again visited the mountain, and one cannot help wonder-
ing if by this time the Matterhorn had not begun to cast over
Whymper some spell which had been ineffective when, as a
youth, he had tackled the mountain bull-in-a-china-shop fashion.
Some modified version of the old feelings blazed up at least
once more. In 1879 Whymper left England for the Andes of
Ecuador, his aim being to discover how men might live and move
at great altitudes. The expedition, which he organised and ran
almost entirely by himself, was a complete success, just as were
almost all the other mountain tasks that he tackled throughouthis life. He made the first and then the second ascent of Chim-
borazo, travelled extensively through the high mountains of
Ecuador, and spent more than thirty nights above 14,000 ft. Onhis return, the Alpine Club held a meeting at the Royal Institu-
tion where Whymper lectured to an audience that included
Edward VII, then Prince of Wales, duly received the vote of
thanks moved by His Royal Highness, and departed to start work
on his monumental Travels amongst the Great Andes of the
Equator.
It was the record of Whymper's last major mountain explora-
tion, an accurate but rather turgid record which lacked all hint of
the fire which had blazed up in parts ofthe Scrambles.
Whymper visited the Rockies three times in the early ipoo's,
but although he made some new ascents on the first of these and
opened up much new country, the journeys were overshadowed
by his dependence on the Canadian Pacific which had com-
missioned him for the task. Significantly, he wrote to Coolidge
shortly before the third visit, suggesting that the latter "might say
V.M. 8* 139
something in a suggestive way about the want ofa book upon the
Rocky Mountains of Canada".
During the last forty years of his life, Whymper's name fails
to occur with the frequency which one might expect, either in
mountain records or in those which dealt with the sociable
meetings of climbers. This must have been all the more galling
to his sense of perspective since he knew that he was, for most
people, the most famous of all living mountaineers. The
audiences which he drew to lectures left no doubt about that.
Yet the cold-shouldering which Whymper appears to have
suffered throughout the greater part of his life was not due either
to the Matterhorn accident or to his upbringing. It was simplythat he was an unclubbable sort of man, a hardly amiable fellow
who would go to considerable lengths to ensure that he gainedthe maximum financial reward for any effort which he expended.He had, for instance, paid especial tribute in his Andes book to
the help which C. E. Mathews had in his typically generous waygiven him in obtaining the necessary official facilities. Mathews,
however, was lecturing on his own experiences in the Alps
lecturing almost entirely to small local societies to whom he
willingly volunteered his time and his energies. Whymper, so soon
as he learned of this, caused his lecture agent to write to Mathews
and bid him discontinue the use of the title "Scrambles in the
Alps" for the talks which Mathews was giving to what were
virtually small groups of friends and acquaintances. Mathews, in
his kindly way, could hardly understand the action. "I have been
his friend for twenty-five years", he wrote in amazement to
Lord Conway.
During the latter years of his life Whymper lived, almost
literally, on the fruits of his explorations, lecturing up and downthe country on his Alpine experiences, telling and re-telling the
Matterhorn story, writing for the popular magazines, and en-
couraging in every possible way the sale of the two guide-bookswhich he later wrote on the history and topography ofChamonixand Zermatt.
He was argumentative, jealous ofhis position, and dhin-skinned
when it came to criticism. The most famous of all his disputes
140
concerned "Aimer's Jump", a jump that has passed into Alpine
history and almost became the subject ofa libel suit. It had taken
pkce in 1864 when Whymper and his party, accompanied byChristian Aimer and Michel Croz, were descending from the
summit of the Ecrins, whose first ascent they had just made.
The incident, shown by Whymper in the Scrambles in a
dramatic full-page illustration, was described by him thus:
We were on the very edge of the arete. On one side was the
enormous precipice facing the Pelvoux, which is not far from
perpendicular; on the other a slope exceeding 50 degrees. A deepnotch brought us to an abrupt halt. Aimer, who was leading,
advanced cautiously to the edge on hands and knees, and peered
over; his care was by no means unnecessary, for the rocks had broken
away from under us unexpectedly several times. In this position he
gazed down for some moments, and then, without a word, turned
his head and looked at us. His face may have expressed apprehensionor alarm, but it certainly did not show hope or joy. We learned
that there was no means of getting down, and that we must, if wewanted to pass the notch,jump across on to an unstable block on the
other side. It was decided that it should be done, and Aimer, with
a larger extent of rope than usual, jumped. The rock swayed as
he came down upon it, but he clutched a large mass with both
arms and brought himselfto anchor.
The incident passed without comment for more than a quarter
of a century after the publication ofWhymper's book. Then, in
an obituary notice on Christian Aimer contributed to the Year-
book of the Swiss Alpine Club, Coolidge re-described the incident
and added a footnote.
After publication of this book (the Scrambles) I immediately
showed this picture to Aimer [said the explosive note] who then
assured me, in all earnest, that he had never done such a thing and
would never have been able to do it.
Whymper, went the implication, had invented the whole "jump"
story to give colour to his account of the Ecrins ascent.
The trouble was immediately brewed up by both sides with
considerable and obvious glee. Whymper wrote to Coolidge.
Coolidge reaffirmed his statement. The Alpine Club, the Swiss
141
Alpine Club, and Horace Walker, the only other member of
Whymper's party then living, were all drawn into the argument.
Whymper asked for, and was refused, a special meeting of the
Alpine Club at which the matter might be thrashed out.
Walker agreed with Whymper's version, and Whymperthereupon threatened a libel action. Coolidge refused to with-
draw his statement and wrote to Tuckett who "was trying to
play mediator between the two men and being soundly criticised
by both: "If he worries me much more he wilier that only be
turned out of all foreign A.C.'s. I am far too useful a member to
be lost save in the eyes ofA.C."
As to the libel threat, Coolidge added: "He will have some
trouble to catch me, an 'alien' living in a foreign land, for a para-
graph published in a foreign land." Finally, Whymper droppedthe libel threat and circulated to all members ofthe Alpine Club
a sixteen-page booklet which included a reproduction of the con-
tested illustration and a generous selection of the letters that had
followed the outbreak of the argument.The fairest summing-up ofthe whole incident came a few years
later in a letter from Captain Farrar to Coolidge.
I do not think W. invented the incident [he said]. Remember he
became a noted man through the Matterhorn affair. He was writinghis first book, which was looked for by the public, and was expectedto be sensational. What more natural than that a clever draughtsmanshould use some little incident to make a sensational picture and
unconsciously exaggerate? We are all human. And who on earth
in those early days ever expected the minute criticism to which
nowadays Alpine matters are, in the fierce light of completed
knowledge, exposed? God help all those early authors and I thank
God that my own very few and far between literary efforts are
written with a determination to make them deadly true if deadly
dry.
It was an apt comment on an argument that might, between'
any other two men, have been solved with a little common sense
and a little courtesy. Neither Whymper nor Coolidge had muchof either.
Yet Whymper was not, as is often imagined, perpetually at
142
loggerlieads with the scholar, ten years his junior, who criticised
in detail so much of his work* The two men corresponded
freely and at times affectionately from 1878 until Whymper'sdeath in 1911, Whymper himself freely admitting to CooHdgemuch that he would have denied in public.
In the second edition [of the Scrambles] several illustrations were
added; and the text was revised. A great many corrections were
made (too numerous to be pointed out). Some were printers*
blunders, others were author's faults. In the fourth edition, I
have endeavoured to lessen both printers* blunders and author's
faults.
There appears, in fact, to have been a good deal of confession
between the two of them.
The friendship even recovered from the discussion of Aimer's
Leap. Early in the new century Whymper was again writing to
Coolidge, and Coolidge was inviting him to the Chalet Montana,his home in Grindelwald, the village to which he had moved in
1896. "When I come, I shall come in the old style," wrote
Whymper, then in his seventies. "Shall walk up, not order rooms
in advance, and take my chance as to finding a room, If none
can be had, I shall camp out."
Finally, he did come, in the hot summer of 1911, sending from
Geneva and Zermatt a series of cards, written in a quavering
unsteady hand, warning Coolidge when to expect him. Hearrived on the morning of September 3, and for nearly a day
conqueror and chronicler ofthe Alps talked together.
It would be interesting to speculate on what passed between the
two men who, between them, had seen the passage of so much
Alpine history, who had seen the sport of climbing transformed
from the quiet passion of the few into a pastime attracting its
thousands, a pastime with its own clubs and traditions and
extensive literature.
It seems likely that in spite of their notorious feuds they bore
one another little permanent ill-will. The extensive correspon-
dence between them suggests, in fact, that each may really have
enjoyed the occasional practise of an engagement with someone
143
as irascible as himself; that each may have felt some sympathy for
an opponent who had as few friends as himself.
Whymper left Coolidge toward evening, travelled to Zer-
matt, then to Geneva and on to Chamonix where he took
a room. He fell ill, refused all aid, and was dead within a few
days.
144
Chapter Seven
COOLIDGE,THE BOSWELL OF THE ALPS
I seek and desire
Even as the wind
That travels the plain
And stirs in the bloom
Ofthe apple-tree.
I wander through life,
With the searching mind
That is never at rest,
Till I reach the shade
Ofmy lover's door.
SAPPHO
J"T"lHE ascent ofthe Matterhorn, even if it had not been accom-
JL panied by tragedy, might easily have brought to an end
the driving force behind the sport of climbing which was
developing so vigorously. It might easily have stultified, beyond
hope of salvation, the growing interest in mountain-climbing for
the peak was, with the exception of the Meije in the Dauphine,the last great unclimbed summit ofthe Alps. The fearful accident
which befell the conquerors an accident which in the eyes of
many was caused by die just and avenging finger of Fate wipingits relentless finger down the slate did, of course, cast a gloomover the years which immediately followed. Yet neither the
ascent of the mountain, nor the accident on the descent, per-
manently crippled the advance of climbing.The reason for the continuation and ultimate resurgence of
mountaineering after 1865 lay simply in the one fact that mendid find in it something more satisfying than mere physical
145
conquest. Just as a Christian can understand a resurrection beyondthe grave, so could a large number of Victorians see, beyond the
Matterhorn disaster, a continuing rightness about mountaineering.
They realised that it was an occupation or even a belief which
could satisfy all manner of unexpected demands in a man. It
might even satisfy the intellectual demands of a scholar whocould see, in the unploughed field of Alpine history, a whole
life's work waiting to be done.
The best example of this was that most peculiar of all Victorian
mountaineers, W. A. B. Coolidge, who first visited Switzerland
in the August of 1865 at the age of fifteen with his aunt, Miss
Meta Brevoort. On that occasion the boy sent back to his mother
from Zermatt the carefully engraved note-paper of the hotel on
which the Matterhorn was shown, adding that "the two dots yousee on the picture represent where they (the victims) fell from,
and where they fell. A horrible distance." This alert, com-
municative correspondent was a weak, slightly pampered, and
rather precocious child whom emotional bad luck and an iron
will were to transform, during the succeeding fifty years, into the
most dominating of Alpine personalities.
It is somewhat surprising that Coolidge, born near New Yorkin 1850 and brought to Europe by his aunt because of his poor
health, ever became a mountaineer at all. He was short, leaning to
plumpness even in early years; he had a rare facility for picking
up and nurturing whatever disease was in range, while even as a
youth his sight was so bad that a breaking ofthe binocle throughwhich he looked at great Alpine views was a major disaster. Yet,
short as he was both of stature and of breath, it was of Coolidgethat Captain Farrar once said that "it would be as ridiculous for a
man to speak of Alpine matters without mentioning the name of
Coolidge, as it would be to discuss the Bible without mentioningGod".
Farrar was making no overstatement. For at that time when
Coolidge, in one of his periodic disputes with the Alpine Club
was breathing fire and destruction on anyone who dared printhis name in the Alpine Journal he had not only been editor of
the Journal for ten years, a member of the Club Committee, and
146
an honorary member of the Club for yet another decade. Hehad made more than 1,700 mountaineering expeditions, including600 grandes courses*, he had, with Lord Conway, edited the first
great series ofclimbing guides to the Alps; he had published score
upon score of articles, books, guides, and notes in which every
aspect of the Alps was listed, scrutinised, and criticised in a detail
and with an accuracy that made comment difficult. He had
become the greatest Alpine historian that the world had ever
known.
Coolidge had realised, early in life, that no one had yet appliedto the history of the Alps and their conquest by man, the same
scholarly scrutiny and investigation which had been lavished on
so many other obscure and esoteric subjects. Remedying this
defect, filling this lacuna in man's knowledge became, as he grewolder, the whole aim and object of his life. His standards were
high and inflexible, their enforcement almost pathological. Onone occasion he condemned a whole book because the author had
letslip one wrong accent. When one ofhis own learned volumes
appeared, an alpine journal decided that Coolidge was the onlyman alive who had the knowledge to review it adequately; he did
so and pointed out with scorn a number of minor errors which
the author had made.
The bare facts of Coolidge' s life suggest that he was a man cast
in no normal mould. Brought as a boy to Europe, he never
returned to the United States and when, during the First World
War, he was refused a passport both by Britain and by the United
States was proud to boast ofhimselfas "the first displaced person".
Due to his mother's bad health he was put in the care of his aunt,
a woman with whom all his early Alpine wanderings were made,
withwhom he existed on terms whose intimacy it is a little difficult
to understand, and whose early death injected a sullen bitterness
into his life which never completely left him. A Fellow, Junior
Dean, and later Librarian of Magdalen, he was ordained in 1882,
held the honorary curacy of South Hinksey, outside Oxford, for
twelve years; and in 1896 retired to Grindelwald where he became
first "the sage" and later a legend within his own lifetime.
He is remarkable not only for what he did, but for why he did
147
it, and for the fact that his climbing enthusiasm arose when it did.
For there was, as he says, a
sort of palsy that fell upon the good cause after that frightful cata-
strophe of July 14, 1865, particularly amongst English climbers.
Few in numbers, all knowing each other personally, shunning the
public as far as possible (and in those days it was possible to do so),
they went about under a sort ofdark shade, looked on with scarcely
disguised contempt by the world of ordinary travellers.
Yet in spite of disabilities added by both nature and events,
Coolidge climbed continuously and strenuously for most of his
active Hfe.
His career, and the factors and events which forced it along its
austere but almost predestined path, divide into four parts. There
is, first, the period ofearly Alpine wanderings with Miss Brevoort,
Coolidge being then a boy who lacked any overwhelminginterest in the mountains. There is, secondly, the period which
started in 1870 with his first visit to the Dauphine, a period duringwhich he travelled on major expeditions through the Alps with
his aunt. There is the period of semi-bibliographical exploration
that followed her death in 1876. And there is the last long periodwhich started when Coolidge moved to Grindelwald in 1896 and
which ended only with his death in 1926.
The young nephew who crossed the Strahlegg Pass in 1865
passing Herr Baedeker "the guide-book gentleman", whoascended the Cima di Jazzi, crossed the Theodule and the Col du
G^ant, ah! with his aunt, drew from her enthusiasm for the Alpineworld some unfiltered essence that was to dominate his life. Hewas happy about the domination. He was a willing hero-wor-
shipper and there can be little doubt that it was his abnormal
affection for her which drove him up into the heights, largely if
metaphorically at the end ofher ice-axe. Her presence gave him,it appears, a new confidence which his own physical disabilities
must have made doubly pleasant.
In 1867 and 1868, they were back again. On the second
occasion they had engaged Christian Aimer, a guide then at the
height of his fame. He had been employed before the Coolidge
148
.o ->:^v :^xt" -./.^"** ./
"
%
./ x^.' -'v', /. .L!:^'^
23 A Letter from W. A. B. Coolidge to his Mother following his first visit to Zermatt
at the age of 15, in 1865
24 Miss Brevoort 25 W. A. B. Coolidge
26, 27 Tschingel, and(left)
the Printed List
of her Peaks and Passes
engagement by Hereford George, who had been unable to tackle
the Finsteraarhorn as planned, and who had therefore released his
guide earlier than was expected.
Aimer turned up before time.
He can't speak a word of either French or English, nor yet under-
stand [Miss Brevoort wrote to her sister]. We immediately unpackedthe dictionary and went to work talking. His son ("young"
Christian) had, I suppose, broken the news of the "Dame" to him,for he expressed no astonishment but sensibly remarked that he
could soon tell after a day's walk with us what and how we could
go. He is a short little man with an honest intelligent face, and verycommunicative.
The meeting was an important one. Under Aimer, Coolidgeand his aunt were to begin their serious mountaineering together;
the links between the Aimer family and Coolidge were to last for
more than half a century. They climbed the Wetterhorn. They
attempted the Finsteraarhorn and the Eiger, and on their repulse
from the latter Coolidge was presented with the immortal dog
Tschingel, who was to accompany him and his aunt on so manyAlpine excursions. The following year they climbed Mont Blanc,
unwittingly making the first known descent by the Bosses- du
Dromedaire. They made a whole series of first-class ascents, and
by the end of the season had already begun to found that legendof "the young American who climbs with his aunt and his dog".
It is the following year that Coolidge, now twenty, first appears
fully formed, out of the chrysalis, a man, a climber, and a planner
all in his own right. He had not only served an apprenticeship on
the mountains by this time but had seen that apprenticeship
acknowledged. Notes to the Alpine Journal had been accepted
and in February he had been elected a member of the Club. In
addition, he had three things of great value to any man wishing
to attempt mountaineering in the heroic manner; the master, the
companion, and the task.
The master was Tuckett. Coolidge had first written to him at
the age of seventeen, cautiously at first, and then with requests for
advice on half a hundred mountain matters from bootmakers to
V.M, 9
aneroids. He had gratefully borrowed equipment which Tuckett
had generously offered; finally, the elder man had become what
Coolidge called his "Alpine godfather" by proposing him for
the Club and guiding him through the necessary formalities
which membership entailed. Coolidge had been an enthusiastic,
not to say persistent admirer, swamping Tuckett with letters,
sometimes twenty or more a month and asking, towards the end
of 1869, for advice on what appears to have been his first literary
project. He received a somewhat cold reply.
A complete list of all first ascents of mountains 10,000 ft. and
upwards would doubtless be interesting but it would involve
immense labour [Tuckett pointed out] and, I fear, expose the
compiler to the risk of being taken to task for the almost invisible
mistakes which questions of priority invariably involve.
There is something ironically amusing about the young Coolidge
being chided against the possibility of making "the almost
invisible mistakes" whose detection was later to become his
speciality, Coolidge was undeterred by Tuckett's coolness and
throughout the winter of 1869-1870 there continued a flow of
almost daily letters from the enthusiastic youth, then at Oxford,to the firmly established gentleman who early in 1870 invited
the young man down to his house near Bristol.
As his companion, Coolidge had his aunt, twenty-five yearshis senior, a woman ofgreat determination and some eccentricitywho was, surprisingly maybe, an ideal companion for her
ambitious nephew. It was she, writing to him in 1876, who madewhat must have been one of the first serious suggestions that
Mount Everest might be attempted.
Coolidge's task, as he saw it in the early seventies, was the
exploration ofthe Dauphine, where he was subsequently to makemore than 250 ascents, many dozens ofthem new. This last greatarea ofunclimbed peaks in Europe, was in those days in much the
same condition as that in which Bonney had found it a decade
previously.
"I am not quite sure what it was that made us choose Dauphineas our battleground," says Coolidge, "but I believe itwas ambition.
152
There was a whole world to explore there and that was enoughfor us/* There was, by this time, an "us" about the matter.
Coolidge, after years of travelling with, and being mastered
by, his aunt, had suddenly become master himself He rises,
for a moment, in real though rather curious stature, and it is
from this moment that his great Alpine career really begins to
flower.
The choice of area might have been different had he been born
even ten years earlier. But during the decade which began in
1860, while Whymper was capturing virgin peaks with an ease
never to be known in Europe again, the Alps shrunk immeasur-
ably. The Ultima Thule of the earlier Alpine world had become
the "new centre" of Coolidge's day, and he was therefore driven
south of the arc into the queer rough land that he was to make
peculiarly his own.
It is interesting to compare Whymper and Coolidge, both
stepping on to the Alpine stage at the age of twenty, both reach-
ing their own predetermined ends, yet one becoming the most
famous of all mountaineers while the other remained, in spite of
his unique accomplishments, almost unknown outside a limited
circle. The backgrounds to their lives were entirely different. It
was not only that by Coolidge's day it was frequently more
difficult to confirm that a peak was unclimbed than it was to
make the ascent. There was one far more significant difference in
the Alpine worlds in which they made their debuts. When
Whymper set out on his first journey to make sketches for Mr.
Longman, mountaineering was at last beginning to justify itself
as a respectable occupation for the eminent Victorians. All
Coolidge's early campaigns were carried out during the aftermath
of the great accident.
There was also the different social status of the two men, a
difference which would not have been so noticeable today. Even
Whymper's addresses they included Lambeth and lodgings in
Teddington have a slightly more proletarian ring than those of
the young boy who at the age of twenty had lived in Concord,
Guernsey, Paris, and Oxford. Whymper, the artist from the
engravers, won the respect ofthe small circle ofmen who climbed
153
regularly, the few for most ofwhom money was rarely a worry;he never became one of them. Coolidge dropped naturally into
that leisured society of carriages, servants, and select musical
evenings. He was an American, it is true, and at times, he must
have appeared a rather unusual specimen to his London friends;
yet he had the essential background, the permanent confidence of
the man who will never have to work for his living, and he took
his place easily and without surprise in the calm assured world
of such men as Conway, Freshfield, Tuckett, and Baillie-Groh-
man. Both Coolidge and Whymper would have preferred life
to treat them differently, and the letters of their later years
suggest how both of them had their regrets Coolidge that he
had not been born a little earlier, Whymper that he had not been
born into a family which would have given him the backgroundto meet Coolidge's certain, constant, and often insupportable
assertion that he alone could be right.
Yet if there were these differences of circumstance between the
two men, there were also similarities of character and ambition
which probably lay at the root of the persistent guerrilla war
between them a war interlarded with long periods of friend-
ship. With each, to be first was the great affair first on the
mountain or first in the recording of its definitive history. For
each, one great peak had a fascination which was almost that of
the supernatural; when Coolidge wrote of the Meije his writing
trembled, as it rarely did, on the verge of inspiration, bringing to
his sentences a hint of that troublesome longing that Edward
Whymper felt for the Matterhorn. Psychologically, both mencame from the same mould; both paid a dear penalty for success,
and the accident on the Matterhorn which so affected Whymper'slife was only a swifter example of that retribution which
slowly overtook Coolidge as his Alpine studies divorced himmore surely, year by year, from the lives of other men and
women.In 1870, however, coming events cast no shadow upon
Coolidge's decision to devote the opening weeks of his Alpine
campaign, as manymen have done since, toretracing at least some
parts of the journey which Whymper, Moore, and Walker had
154
made through the Dauphine six years earlier, and in climbing a
number of the peaks which their hurried passage had left tin-
climbed. He had borrowed a number of the original sketches
which Tuckett had made of the area in 1862; together with Miss
Brevoort, he had gained a brief glimpse of Moore's Alps in 1864,
then only privately printed, and both of them had read Bonney'sOutline Sketches in the High Alps ofDauphin^. There was little else
that dealt with mountaineering in the area the Scrambles was not
published until 1871 and when Coolidge set out from his
mother's home in Paris in the summer of 1870 he had justifiable
hopes of starting a career as a genuine pioneer.
It was a queer trio which drove through the streets from Mrs.
Coolidge's house to take their places in die express to the South.
Except for Coolidge's axe Miss Brevoort never carried one,
preferring the long wooden baton which one associates with the
early prints of Mont Blanc it would have been difficult to
identify them as mountaineers.
Miss Brevoort was slow-moving and, it must be imagined, a
little ponderous in the thick and voluminous clothes with which
she ceaselessly experimented but which she was unable to convert
satisfactorily to mountaineering. Coolidge once complained
vehemently that she was not, as described by a casual writer, a
"grosse hollandische-amerikanische Miss" but was, on the con-
trary, "slight and tall". Both writers appear to have been
extremists.
Coolidge seemed even less of a mountaineer than his aunt, the
complete contrast to Martin Conway, the beau ideal of a slightly
later period, whose tall figure, flowing hair, and fine moustachios
combined with his dual reputation as an art critic and a moun-
taineer, and created about him an air which would have been
theatrical had it not been for the man himself.
The third member of the party was the small bitch Tschingel,
already a veteran in her own quiet way.In die minor hall of fame which the Victorian mountaineers
carefully built for themselves, Tschingel deserves a place of her
own. She did, after all, make a total of sixty-six major climbs, as
well as about 100 minor ones; she did form the final third of the
155
legendary trio; and she was to become, as Miss Brevoort proudly
termed her, the only "Honorary Lady member of the Alpine
Club".
Tschingel was by no means the first dog to be taken into the
ice-world ofthe Alps. Marc-Theodore Bourrit, one ofthe earliest
of Alpine writers, travelled in the mountains for six years with
his dog. De Saussure invariably travelled with his. Yet it was
left to an Englishman to take a dog on the first really high Alpine
climb. He was Henry Atkinson who, as was almost demanded
at the time, followed up his ascent ofMont Blanc in 1837 with a
slim pamphlet describing the experience. In it he gives one of
the first descriptions of what a dog thought of the upper
world.
It was a little dog [he says] which belonged to one of the guides,
Michael Balmat, which accompanied us the whole day, and was the
first dog that ever reached the top of Mont Blanc. He was much
affected with drowsiness after we quitted the Grand Plateau, and
every time we stopped he tried to lie down on our feet, finding the
snow cold. He evinced many tokens of surprise by frequently
staring about him, and would make an effort to run very fast and
then drop. With regard to his appetite, chicken bones disappeared
with an amazing rapidity, but he did not appear to suffer from
thirst.
It seems likely that this was the animal described by GeorgeBarnard, the artist who copied an account from one ofLongman's
privately printed books, and who says that the guide wanted to
take the dog, but that permission was refused by his party who
thought it would be a nuisance.
Of course, it soon overtook them, though the guide protestedthat he had ordered it to be tied up [says Barnard]. Well, the dogwas a trouble, he got between their legs, and bothered them, and
they were obliged to throw him over all the crevasses. He waswhat is called a Spitz dog, a kind distinguished by a very pointednose, sharp black eyes, and a tail curling stiffly over the back. Themountain atmosphere had an extraordinary effect on this dog; it
made him uncurl his tail! As he went up, this bushy appendage
156
gradually got straighter and straighter, till at last it hung downbehind as straight as a broomstick. No Spitz dog's tail was ever
before known to uncurl, and curiously enough as he came down his
tail by degrees curled up again as usual.
A later canine climber was the little dog who accompanied
Kennedy on many of his Alpine travels in the i86o's and whomade the ascent of the 13,500 ft. Aiguille Verte with her master.
She disliked some ofthe hard snow slopes, Kennedy reported, but
persevered on to the top and then went to sleep on a rucksack
while everyone else admired the view.
Yet all the mountaineering dogs of which records have sur-
vived are faint shadows compared with the incomparable
Tschingel who for nine glorious seasons rollicked across the Alpswith Coolidge and his aunt.
Tschingel has been variously described a bull terrier, a small
bloodhound, a large beagle. She was I foot 7 inches high, and
she had a brown silky coat with white breast, stomach, stockingsand muzzle, and very large brown eyes. Her favourite drinks on
the mountain were very human red wine or weak tea while
although she understood English, German and the dialect of the
Canton Valais in Switzerland, she never responded to French.
Coolidge always maintained that this was due to her decided
views about the Franco-PrussianWar which in 1870 involved her
in an arduous journey across Europe when she travelled home to
Britain with her owners.
Tschingel was born in the spring of 1865, in a small village in
the Bernese Oberland, and little is known of the first few months
of her life. The following September, however, she was frisking
in front of her home when Christian Aimer passed by, liked the
look of the small dog, bought her for ten francs, and induced her
to follow him on foot.
Aimer was on his way to join George, and join him he did
together with the dog who trotted up steps cut in a steep ice-
slope to meet the party and "excited the admiration of all the
spectators by the unconcerned way in which he trotted up the
slope". The mistake about the sex ofthe animal was one that was
only tardily corrected; Miss Brevoort stubbornly continued to
157
speak of Tschingel as "he", long after the animal had producedmore than thirty puppies.
At the end of Aimer's engagement with George in the autumn
of 1865, Tschingel named after the first glacier pass that she
crossed was taken back to the guide's home in Grindelwald, and
there the story of her mountaineering might well have ended.
Three years later, however, Coolidge and his aunt were turned
back by bad weather on the Eiger; and, to lessen Coolidge's dis-
appointment he was only eighteen at the time Aimer made
him a present of Tschingel. The same year she began her main
Alpine wanderings, travelling with the Coolidge party on all
except the most difficult climbs.
Tschingel was taken to and from the Alps in a specially built
travelling box. On the mountains themselves, she usually trotted
along as one of the party. Sometimes a rope would be looped
through her workaday collar, and she then became physically
linked to the people on either side of her. Her paws sometimes
bled, but that did not appear to worry her, and she kicked off the
special leather boots which Coolidge had made for her.
Like many other dogs, she was particularly good at finding her
way across thickly crevassed glaciers, and on at least one occasion
helped to find the way home when the guide had lost it; an
ability which some scientists explain by the fact that a dog's super-
sensitive nose can "scent" the old air that comes up through the
crevasses from the depths of the glacier. Writing to her sister of
Tschingel, Miss Brevoort explains how the party once crossed
the Grindelwald Glacier and adds:
In one place, we had to cross a very rotten-looking and pretty
long snow bridge, but by stretching a rope along it and going one
by one (Tschingel was tied and walked along it alone quite solemnly)we got safely over.
Tschingel climbed the Jungfrau, and a number of other well-
known summits, but Mont Blanc was probably her most famous
climb, for it had always been suspected that the dog which wentwith the Atkinson party might have broken the rules and been
carried for a short distance. Tschingel certainly went all the
way on her own four feet, and when she returned from the
158
28 W. A. B. CooHdge (left)and Albert, his manservant, at the Chalet Montana,
Grindelwald, in 1920
summit in 1875 a special cannon was fired at Chamonix in her
honour.
She trotted into the village with her head erect and her tail
wagging, immensely proud of herself [Miss Brevoort wrote to her
sister]. The next day, lying luxuriously on a sofa in the hotel
drawing-room she held a kind of state reception which was attended
by several hundred persons, including all the guides.
Tschingel never climbed the Matterhorn, although Coolidgehad great plans for her to do so in 1876. When his idea matured,
he was in one part ofthe Alps and Miss Brevoort, with Tschingel,was in another. Miss Brevoort needed quite a lot of convincing;
finally, she agreed, in principle, that Tschingel could make the
ascent to crown her career. But, she added, "I can't bear to think
of his doing this without seeing him do it, and as to our going to
Zermatt it's not to be thought of, Dear Will, in spite of your
economy." Could it not, she implied, be left for another year?
Coolidge let the matter rest for that season. Another never
came.
As Tschingel grew old, her coat grew white, she became almost
blind, and her teeth dropped out. But although she no longer
climbed, she still sometimes wore her Sunday-best collar, with its
little silver medallions recording all the peaks she had climbed,
and the passes she had crossed. Finally in 1879, Coolidge decided
that it was kinder to have her put away. The night after he had
made the decision, Tschingel died in her sleep before the kitchen
fire.
I am at present in great affliction at the death ofmy dear old dog
Tschingel, which took place on June 16 [Coolidge wrote to C. E.
Mathews]. She was so much more a companion than a mere dogthat I feel her loss very deeply.
Coolidge never forgot her and when, nearly half a century
later, he had another dog, it was a black Newfoundland as
dissimilar as possible from Tschingel.
It was some forty years after Tschingers death that Coolidge
was visited in his Grindelwald home by Dr. Monroe Thorington,
the great American climber and Alpine historian.
V.M. 10 l6l
He had his man show me about [Dr. Thorington once said].
And then, just when I was leaving he pointed to the door. There
on a hook was Tschingel's collar with the litde bangles shining in the
sun. Not a word was said, but Coolidge managed something
resembling a smile.
In mid- and later life, as Coolidge gathered around himself the
impedimenta and glory ofan Alpine expert, he was as meticulous
about the record of Tschingel as of that of any human being.
His letter to one gentleman who had rashly published a short
history of the dog without checking with the Master was typical
not only ofhis attitude to Tschingel but ofthe whole latter half
of his life.
I have only just had time to look at your article on my dog
Tschingel [he said] and write at once to protest very strongly against
the remarks you have made as regards my dear aunt, and against the
numerous mistakes offact in this short article. I supplied you with the
printed authentic facts, to which you have paid but little attention.
Tschingel walked from Kippel up the Torrenthorn, and was not
carried. My aunt did not meet T. on the Torrenthorn, which she never
climbed in all her life, while at the moment of T.'s ascent she was
with me near Zermatt. She did not make the ist ascent of the
Jungfrau from the N., but the first by a woman. She made the ist
ladys ascent of the Silberhorn, not the 3rd, our ascent having been
the third ever made (Baedeker in 1863 and Hornby and Philpott in
1865 were our only predecessors on the peak). At least two other
ladies (Fraulein Brunner of Berne and Miss Walker) had been upthe Gr. Schreckhorn before her. The whole Torrenthorn story is a
myth so far as regards my aunt's presence there. She never saw T. till
1868, and then in H. du Grd. Eiger, here, not in Aimer's house
which she never visited. The gift of T. was made by Aimer to me,
and took place at a chalet a litde above the Hotel at Alpiglen, on
this slope ofthe Kl. Scheidegg. It was to console me for afailure on
the Eiger (due to verglas on the rocks), a peak which T. never
climbed till 1871. The Blumlisalphorn was the first snow peakclimbed (1868) by T. with us. My aunt was not a "grosse hollan-
dische-amerikanische Miss". She was slight and tall, while she
never lived in Holland in her life, though her family came thence
to New York about 1700. The ascent ofthe Diablerets was in 1870,
162
not in 1872. My aunt was perfectly well in 1876 in Switzerland,and continued so until Dec. 14, 1876, when she was attacked byrheumatic fever, which went to her heart and killed her on the
I9th Dec. 1876. In 1870, T. was with us all summer, and her son Bello
was born before we ever saw her in 1868 for the first time. Aimerwas not our guide on the Diablerets, but a man from Plan des lies.
I greatly regret that you should have taken so little trouble in this
matter, and would certainly not have sanctioned the appearance of
the article had I seen it before publication. All the true facts as to
T. are given in the 2 pamphlets I lent you, and it was quite un-
necessary to invent new ones. That is not the right way to write
history.
Little of this justified testiness appears to have clouded the
young Coolidge's mind as he set out with Miss Brevoort for the
first great Dauphine campaign of 1870. Their achievements were
remarkable. They met Christian Aimer and his son, "youngChristian" the former being joyfully recognised by Tschingelto the pleasure of all and together made the first ascent of the
central peak of the Meije, the first ascent ofthe Ailefroide, and the
third ascent of the Ecrins which Whymper had climbed for the
first time only six years previously. They climbed the Pelvoux,
then drove south by carriage across the frontier to Courmayeur,whence Coolidge made the second ascent ofMont Blanc by the
Brenva route, watched with anxious eyes through a telescope byMiss Brevoort. They joined forces again, made the fifth ascent
of the Dent Blanche, attempted the Weisshorn, climbed the
Dom, and made a number of other less important ascents before
returning to England via the tortuous and inconvenient route
necessitated by the Franco-PrussianWar.
The ideal pattern of Coolidge's life had been set, and it was to
be followed for the next six years during which he built up the
foundation of his unique experience. Nine or ten months of the
year were divided between work at Oxford where he became
a Fellow of Magdalen in 1875 visits to his aunt's establishment
at Dorking, Surrey, and journeys to London where his presence
in any dispute then brewing could be used to better effect. It was
a satisfying and rather pleasant existence, almost insulated by
163
scholarship and money from the outer world which at times
inconveniently intruded on his ideas (". . . in that case Russia
will come forward and there will be an European war, when
of course my poor Dolomite plan must go to the wall", he
wrote).
In 1871 Coolidge and Miss Brevoort visited the Oberland and
the Pennines, Miss Brevoort losing the first lady's ascent of the
Matterhorn to Lucy Walker, but gaining, as compensation, the
first lady's traverse of the peak from Zermatt to Breuil. One
unexpected result of the campaign was the famous paper in the
Alpine Journal which described "A Day and a Night on the
Bietschhorn", famous because although signed by Coolidge it
was in fact written by Miss Brevoort, excluded by her sex from
both the Alpine Club and its journal.
The following year they again went to the Oberland after onlya brief visit to the Dauphine; and, the following year, to the
Dauphine again. Early in 1874, they started the fashion for
winter climbing by visiting the Oberland and making the first
winter ascents of the Wetterhorn and the Jungfrau, an appetiser
for yet another visit to Dauphine later in the year. There came a
visit to the Mont Blanc range in 1875 and in the following year
another winter campaign in the Alps during which three un-
successful attempts were made to climb Mont Blanc for the first
time at that season and a three-month summer campaign that
ranged along the Alps from the Dauphine to the Dolomites.
Throughout all these expeditions in the early 1870'$, the
practice was for Coolidge and Miss Brevoort to make a number
of climbs together, for them to separate in order to carry out anyindividual plans which they might have made, and to keep in
touch with one another by an almost daily series of letters which
criss-crossed the minor ranges and recounted the previous day's
exploits. Tschingel, in general, stayed with Miss Brevoort,
Coolidge, away from Miss Brevoort, generally climbed only with
his guides, invariably the Aimers, although it was during these
years that he began his acquaintance with Arthur Fairbanks, a
man of his own age, and with his lifelong friend Frederick
Gardiner. He climbed with both as occasion and convenience
164
demanded. It was obvious that he preferred the companionshipof Miss Brevoort. Then in December 1876, came her sudden
death.
Coolidge never quite recovered. With Meta Brevoort gone,the world would never again be quite the same place. Her death
did more than create in Coolidge an abnormal affection for the
Alps wherein he raised her shadow; it illuminated the way in
which the mountains might carry out a dual emotional and
intellectual task in the mind of a man suitably placed by circum-
stance. Coolidge had been inordinately fond ofhis aunt and with
her death he was driven back on himself; simultaneously, he
realised that no one had yet applied to mountains and moun-
taineering the technique of the historian. He had only to do so
to satisfy an academic longing and, at the same time, keep alive
in his mind a whole series of memories from happier days.
Circumstances provided, ready-made, an intellectual field into
which his emotions could be driven without too much risk of
disaster.
After the death of Miss Brevoort, Coolidge's life altered;
steadily he began to withdraw himselfmore closely into University
life, and into the academic problems of Alpine history which
were to be his solace for two lonely decades in Britain. In 1882
he took Holy Orders which gave effect, he said, to the wish of
one whose memory was dear to him. Only two things worried
him in entering the Church, he admitted. One was his dislike of
having to carry out parochial work; the second was what he
referred to as one circumstance in his own life which made him
wish for the grace of Orders.
His interest in mountains did not diminish; it changed emphasis
slightly and veered more and more towards the solution of
historical problems, to the amassing of knowledge for its ownsake. Coolidge continued to travel abroad each year without
Tschingel now, for during the last three years of her life she was
not fit enough for the restless journeyings which he carried out.
He continued to increase his akeady vast number of ascents, and
he began to build into formidable proportions his considerable
fame as an Alpine historiographer. The question of whether the
165
original route up one particular Alpine ridge went left or right
of one particular rock pinnacle would involve him for weeks
in a heated and much-enjoyed argument with whomsoever was
rash enough to challenge his view. He once filled pages on the
question of whether or not there should be an accent over the
word chalet. He had little sense ofproportion, an overwhelmingfear of showing his emotions, and the result was that for those
beyond the small circle of Alpine enthusiasts his writings were
slightly repellent with unexplained facts and figures. Even the
enthusiasts were not always happy. "I personally cannot forgive
him", wrote one climber, "for ... the fact that he never tried
seriously to communicate to the world the knowledge which
he possessed, but was content to fling it out in a disorderly
mess."
In 1880 he became editor of the AlpineJournal in succession to
Douglas Freshfield, a post which brought him into touch, and
frequently into conflict, with the leading mountaineers of the
period. His fame was already such that not only experiencedmountaineers but also embryonic climbers, topographers, map-makers, the newspapers, and even dear old souls who wanted a
quiet holiday in Switzerland, wrote to Coolidge for advice.
They invariably got it, courteously, in extenso, and most
annoying thing of all for his enemies correctly.
Only when Coolidge's accuracy was questioned, when his
opinions were challenged, or when he imagined that he was the
butt of some sly joke that he scarcely comprehended, only then
did he really rise in his anger and show, as one critic expressed
it, that "in his one-sidedness, savagery, and bitterness he was
medieval".
He was easy to cross, and somewhat feared, as is shown by the
small illustration which appears in the volume of the Badminton
library that deals with mountaineering. This shows railway
porters manhandling the baggage and impedimenta of what is
obviously a group of climbing friends on their way to the Alps.The original sketch was drawn by that austere autocrat, Sir
Edward Davidson, Coolidge's opponent in one of the mostbitter ofAlpine controversies; on die luggage Davidson inscribed
166
the initials C. T. D. (Clinton Dent), D. W. F. pouglas Fresh-
field), W. M. C. (William Martin Conway), and, A. J. B. (A. J.
Butler, another of Coolidge's opponents, about whom he wrote
virulent, not to say scurrilous, letters); and, flying from the
parrot cage perched on A. J. B.'s luggage, he put a tag with the
initials W. A. B. C. At the special request of the editor, whofeared a libel suit, the initials were finally altered to A. B. C.
Coolidge had already justified the writer of The Times9
obituarywho described him as an adept in the gentle art ofmaking enemies
and a man who regarded a hatchet as an instrument not for
burying but for use.
Coolidge had always suffered from bad health. He had no
particular love of either Britain or the British mountains he had
no interest either in the British hills, to which the Pilkingtons tried
to entice him, or in the Himalayas and in 1896 he moved from
Oxford to Grindelwald, first taking up residence with the Aimers
and then renting his own house, the Chalet Montana, in the
village. Here, among his Alpine library ofsome 15,000 volumes,
he became a legend; from "the fiery lamb" he was gradually
transformed into "the sage of Grindelwald". It was here that his
best and most scholarly work was done.
Earlier, he had revised Murray's Switzerland; he had become
the Alpine contributor to the Encyclopaedia Britannica, contributing
more than 200 articles to one edition of the work, and of half a
dozen other popular encyclopaediae. He had produced Swiss
Travel and Swiss Guide-Books, an erudite, unreadable, volume
in which Leslie Stephen found "a great deal of interesting
matter".
You have, I think [Stephen continued in a letter to Coolidge]
conclusively proved one point viz. that you should write a "special"
guidebook, die speciality in your case being history. Even in myscrambles, I used often to think that a book enabling one to look on
a few historical associations to Alpine sites would greatly add to the
pleasure; and I am sure that if done with discretion i.e. not makingtoo severe demands upon the general reader, a most charming book
might be put together. You could do it admirably, though I admit
that the task would not be a light one.
167
Coolidge glossed over the charm, but before his move to
Grindelwald he had contributed many of the 220 items in the
bibliography of his writings which he later had privately
printed.
At Grindelwald, less disturbed by friends and acquaintances, he
produced his major works. The first was a new edition of Ball's
Guide to the Western Alps, a publication over which he had
quarrelled with the Alpine Club for years. There were arguments
about how the revision ofBall which by the 1890*5 was seriously
out ofdate should be handled; about who the helpers should be,
and on the amount of editorial authority that Coolidge should
have over them. There were, after all, many precedents for
similar disputes Coolidge had resigned from his post as editor
of Murray when John Murray refused to print Coolidge's
libellous note on an Alpine hotel. Coolidge had taken on Ball
in 1893 but illness, and his residence abroad, conspired to delay
publication of the volume until 1898. The next year he resigned
from the Alpine Club after a dispute over the second volume of
the work.
Although Coolidge was to be made an honorary member of
the Club in 1904 an honorary membership which he resigned
six years later following yet another dispute the break of 1899
somehow underlined his divorce from Britain and his thirty-year
residence there. Alpine history had become more than the
passion of his life; it had become life itself.
Cared for by Albert his manservant, rarely going into the
village of Grindelwald yet succeeding in quarrelling with
"yomg" Christian Aimer, and somehow knowing most of the
village gossip Coolidge worked with and for his library of
books that overflowed into the corridors and rooms ofhis house.
With their help he produced, in 1904, the monumental Josias
Simler et les Origines de FAlpinisme jusquob 1600, a book whose
character can be gathered from the fact that it contained 190
pages ofintroduction, 307 of text, 130 ofnotes, 327 ofappendices,62 of notes on the appendices, and a 29-page index. Four years
later there came The Alps in Nature and History, a volume in
which Coolidge for the first time began to interpolate some
168
of his own reminiscences, a practice he expanded in AlpineStudies four years later. In every other way Coolidge remained
the same unemotional recording-machine of facts, dates, and
figures.
When war broke out in 1914 he applied for a British passportsince he no longer qualified for U.S. citizenship. The British
refused, on the grounds that he had not spent the previous few
years in Britain and therefore lacked a residence qualification.
Coolidge argued; he had, he pointed out, sworn allegiance to the
Queen once when he became a Fellow of Magdalen and yet
again when he took Holy Orders. He still failed to get his pass-
port, and became both "the man without a country" and "the
first displaced person".
During the latter years of the war he began editing the vast
diaries ofhis old friend, Tuckett, and these were finally published,
in 1920, as A Pioneer in the High Alps. Coolidge was by this time
thinking ofthe future; what worried him most was the fate ofthe
great library which he had built up over the years. In 1907 he had
offered the Alpine portion ofit to the Alpine Club; the President,
in thanking him for the offer, had not unnaturally suggested that
the offer should be put in legal form. Coolidge, leaping at the
chance of taking umbrage, replied furiously and suggested that
the offer had been turned down. Now, in the early 1920'$, he
was thinking again.
First, he considered giving at least a portion of it to the John
Rylands Library in Manchester, and in a letter to a friend discussing
the matter he described the collection, which was insured for
3,000.
I hope that ifyou ever come to this place [Grindelwald], you will
look in on me, and examine my library of 16,000 volumes,
particularly the Alpine and the Swiss History portions. It represents
the accumulations of 50 years, for I am now yij years of age. It
fills 12 rooms of the rather large wooden house which I inhabit,
and its disposal has given me a good deal of trouble, as I wished
certain portions of it to be kept together, if possible. I first offered
the Alpine portion, with various Alpine curiosities, to the Alpine
Club ofLondon as a free legacy. I was much surprised when this
V.M. ii 171
offer was refused, on the strange ground that I could give certain
books, but not a whole section of the library. So I had to look
around. The Bodleian desired to purchase the Alpine and Swiss
history portions, but insisted on an immediate purchase (this was
before the war), to which I could not consent, as I did not feel that
my literary activity was yet ended and required that it should be
valued by an English expert, to which I could not consent for I do
not think any English expert is capable of valuing, at any rate, the
Swiss history portion. So I fell back, as to the Alpine portion, on
a very old and intimate Liverpool friend, rather older than I was
but unluckily he died in 1919!
Finally, the library was bequeathed to the Swiss Alpine Club.
Coolidge died in 1926. Almost until the end he was still
sending out his famous yellow postcards, either badly typed or
inscribed in a small spidery writing with pertinent comments on
some Alpine controversy. Almost until the end he was visited byold Alpine friends from Britain who would call and be received
by him, and then be shown round his library. For the people of
Grindelwald who to this day care for his grave in Grindelwald
churchyard he had a curiosity value; he belonged to the past
that had existed before the cult of mountains had begun.
His great knowledge, expended without stint for the benefit of
mountaineers of the world, gave him such a claim to universal
recognition that any foibles were willingly accepted [said one
mountaineer who had crossed swords with him more than once].But for his great labours he would have no doubt been considered a
quarrelsome old devil.
More of his friends would have been present at the funeral had
it not been for the General Strike. As it was, the whole of
Grindelwald turned out, men, women, and children standing in
the keen air of the lovely spring day or following the cortege as
it wound from the Chalet Montana, at the southern end of the
village, past the English church where Coolidge had preachedmore than once, up the gentle rise to the little church beneath
the shadow of the Wetterhorn.
The sun shone brilliantly, occasionally loosening the winter
snow still lying on the heights. As the coffin was lowered into
172
the grave there came the distant rumble ofan avalanche, pouringoff the cliffs of the Eiger, a last tribute from the mountains at
whose significance Coolidge might openly have scoffed bet
which he would have privately considered no more Ms
doe.
173
Chapter Eight
THE WOMENWith head on high she trod,
A youthful, seeking, maid,
With eyes alightfor distant height
Unawed and unafraid.
How can we seek an equal peakWhere we can walk with God?
ANON.
MISSBREVOORT, whose attraction to mountain-climb-
ing had so influenced Coolidge's whole life, was one ofthe
first women to make any number of serious high Alpine climbs.
She followed the example of Lucy Walker, another remarkable
woman who was the daughter of one enthusiastic Liverpool
climber and the sister of another; between them Miss Brevoort
and Miss Walter account for most of the important climbs made
by women during the i86o's.
Before their day, two women had climbed Mont Blanc
Maria Paradis in 1809 and Henriette d'Angeville in 1838 but
both ascents were exceptional events, the first being made for
profit and the second for the notoriety which it gave.
Maria, an eighteen-year-old peasant girl who owned a small
stall near the foot of the mountain, did not enjoy the ascent.
"Throw me into a crevasse and go on yourselves", she imploredher guides. They humanely ignored her request, dragged her
to the top, where she arrived in poor condition, and brought her
safely back to Chamonix.
Henriette d'Angeville, the "thwarted maiden lady in her
forties" as she has been called, was of different metal. "She goesas well as we do and fears nothing", said one of her guides, all
of whom were so impressed with her performance that on
174
reaching the summit they lifted her on their shoulders, saying as
they did so: "Now, Mademoiselle, you shall go one higher than
Mont Blanc." Being a staunch Royalist, she drank a bumper of
champagne to the Comte de Paris, and then despatched a carrier
pigeon with the news of her success. Her dress, in which she
was later painted, consisted of a long-skirted garment which
she wore over brightly checkered peg-top trousers, an outfit
chosen, one must assume, for its publicity value rather than its
utility.
Throughout the 1840'$ and 1850'$, a number ofwomen beganto travel through the less-known parts of the Alps even though
they did not make any major ascents. The wives of GeorgeBarnard and Michael Faraday went with their husbands on a
leisurely tour of the Oberland in 1841. In the following decade
the wives of Gilbert and Churchill accompanied the party which
made pioneering journeys through the Dolomites. Mrs. Fresh-
field, mother ofDouglas Freshfield, and Mrs. Cole, both travelled
around and across the Alps during the iSso's, and Mrs. Wills was
taken for a night on the Mer de Glace while on her honeymoon.There were also the two unknown ladies "past the noon of life",
whom Mrs. Cole met in Aosta after they had just crossed the
Mont Blanc range with a single guide.
Two things combined to hinder the growth of mountain-
climbing among women. One was the belief that it was not a
womanly occupation, a belief which was expressed until well
past the turn of the century. The second was the problem of
clothes.
The male attitude was well described by Ellen Pigeon, one of
two famous sisters who in 1869 made the first crossing of the
Sesiajoch into Italy and took charge of the party when their
solitary guide lost the way.
In days gone by [she wrote to Coolidge in 1892] many A.C/s
would not speak to us, though no one was so impertinent as "the
king of the Riffel". Now, people are accustomed to lady climbers,
and even solitary ones. We were the first, I think, to go unattended
by a male protector, and we got on very well, but then two together
must be pleasanter than one alone, when you must have guides.
175
"The king of the RiflfeT was Sir W. E. Davidson, Permanent
Legal Adviser to the Foreign Office for more than thirty years,
who between 1875 and his retirement from active mountaineering
nearly forty years later, climbed the Riffelhorn above Zermatt
250 times. Aloof, distinguished, highly critical of innovation,
he held opinions on the propriety of women on the mountains
that may well be imagined even though they have nowhere been
recorded.
Even as late as 1879, the feeling against women climbers was
strong, and Mrs. Aubrey le Blond, the remarkable thrice-married
woman who was the founder of the first woman's climbing club
in Britain, met considerable opposition.
I had to struggle hard for my freedom [she says]. My mother
faced the music on my behalfwhen my grand aunt, Lady Bentinck,
sent out a frantic S.O.S. "Stop her climbing mountains. She is
scandalising all London and looks like a Red Indian."
The second thing whichhampered the development ofclimbing
among women was the question ofdress. Some ofthe first advice
came from Mrs. Cole.
Every lady engaged on an Alpine journey should have a dress of
some light woollen material, such as carmelite or alpaca which, in
the case of bad weather, does not look utterly forlorn when it has
once been wetted and dried [she advised].
Small rings should be sewn inside the seam ofthe dress, and a cord
passed through them, the ends ofwhich should be knotted togetherin such a way that the whole dress may be drawn up at a moment's
notice, to the required height. A riding skirt, without a body, whichcan be slipped offand on in a moment, is also invaluable.
The "slipping on and off" school grew throughout the years,A skirt was invariably considered necessary for appearances when
leaving or arriving at an Alpine inn or hotel; breeches or their
equivalent were essential to the conquest of certain mountain
obstacles, and to the safe traverse ofmore than one narrow ridge.The discardable skirt theory could bring its own penalties,
however, and it was Mrs. Aubrey le Blond, when traversing the
Zinal Rothhorn, who remembered on approaching Zinal that she
176
had left her skirt on the far side of the mountain, and was forced
to retrace most ofher day's route.
Miss Brevoort, who on at least one occasion was driven to the
use of trousers, was perpetually experimenting, and records that:
"My dress plan, too, has failed, and descending snow slopes the
snow enters the rings and stuffs up the hem and makes me heavyand wet. I have had to baste up both dress and skirt."
Yet Meta Brevoort' s model, Miss Lucy Walker, never used
the subterfuge of men's clothes, wearing on the mountains a
white print dress whose shape she carefully had "renewed"
whenever an expedition was finished.
In the self-assured way in which she made her early ascents,
Lucy Walker was typical of the new race of women which the
Victorian Age produced. She "aspired" to the mountains; she
felt drawn to them by an inexpressible attraction whose tightness,
had it ever been in doubt, would have been assured by the fact
that her father and brother were ardent devotees of the sport,
Lucy Walker knew that climbing was better than the other occupa-tions in which ladies could indulge. It brought her into contact
with nature; it gave her the illusion of danger which had almost
been removed from the world in which she moved; it gave her
contacts with a world ofpeople different from those she normallyknew. It brought her, with its combination of excitement,
beauty, and exaltation, to the edge of a new world.
Her first glimpse of that world came in 1859. Lucy Walker
was twenty-eight at the time, a spectacled, darkly ringletted
young woman, amply fashioned and kindly. She had arrived at
the Schwarenbach Inn with her family, wished to make the
ascent of the Altels, and was told by her father that Melchior
Anderegg was the best guide for the expedition. Outside the
inn, she asked a young man, apparently a porter, where she could
find the famous guide. Drawing himself up to his full height, he
replied with dignity, "I am Anderegg." It was the beginning of
a long and increasingly friendly association. During the following
twenty-one years, Lucy Walker made ninety-eight expeditions,
only three of them unsuccessfully, mostly in the company of
her brother, her father, or Melchior Anderegg. In all of these
177
adventures she consistently refused to dress like a man, main-
taining with perfect reason that she preferred to travel thus even
if it did slightly limit her climbing.
Her views were strong, and she was always pleased to explain
why she had not climbed one particular summit. "You said that
no woman could manage it", a certain woman climber had said
to a well-known mountaineer after her ascent ofthe peak. "No",he replied, "I said, 'No lady'/'
On the mountains she took nothing to eat except sponge-cake
and champagne or sometimes asti both wines which she found
ideal in combating the slight mountain-sickness from which she
suffered throughout the whole ofher climbing career. She did not
ride, fish, or even walk with any particular enthusiasm, her only
outdoor exercise other than climbing being the gentle one of
croquet.
Among the few women who climbed during the same years
as did Lucy Walker, were Emmeline Lewis-Lloyd and Miss
Straton, a remarkable couple who invariably travelled on the
mountains together. Miss Lloyd, brought up at Nantgwyllt in
mid-Wales, a great house which was swamped when the Elan
Dam was built to create the water-supply for Birmingham, was
a famous local sportswoman. Short, stout, andjovial, she enjoyedthe reputation of once having played a salmon from sunrise to
sundown, after which the local population came to regale her in
the battle, with drink and sandwiches.
She enters into early mountaineering quite confident and self-
assured, and appears rarely to have been surprised at any turn
which events might take. One evening she was completing a
solitary scramble in the snow above Gressoney when there
appeared in the distance a figure which seemed to be that of a
local chamois-hunter. He came up to her, bowed, and began to
talk with her in perfect English; discussing the mountains, he
escorted her back to her hotel where he was apparently known to
the staff. After he had left, Miss Lloyd casually asked his name.
"King Victor-Emmanuel", she was told.
Until 1873, Miss Lewis-Lloyd's most constant companion onthe mountains was a character remarkable at any time, a spinster
178
Two OF THE LATER
VICTORIAN WOMENCLIMBERS
33 Mrs. Jackson
34
Miss Maud Meyer
endowed with .4,000 a year who married her Alpine guide and
lived happily with him for the rest of her life. Miss Straton,
who achieved the remarkable feat, first visited the Alps in 1861
at the age of twenty-three, but it was not until four years later
that she began a long series of Alpine excursions, many of themin the company of Jean Charlet of Chamonix. She appears to
have met him first at Nantgwyllt, where he had been brought byMiss Lloyd to work as a groom for a year. She travelled with
him in the Pyrenees, then in the Alps where she made four
ascents of Mont Blanc married him and settled happily in a
small home near Chamonix where she spent the rest of her life.
Of their two sons, one was later to climb Mont Blanc at the ageof thirteen, the other at the age of eleven and a half. Neither,
Miss Straton later proudly recorded, needed special help.
Both Miss Straton and Miss Lewis-Lloyd appear to have been
attracted to mountaineering largely because they felt it wrongthat any pastime should be reserved for the male sex alone.
They tackled the situation with energy, courage, determination,
and the banner of emancipation flying high. It seems unlikely
that they were moved by the mountains in quite the same wayas Lucy Walker and Meta Brevoort, although they had attemptedthe Matterhorn as early as 1869.
Miss Brevoort, whose Alpine story is so closely linked with
that of Coolidge, was brought up in a Paris convent school. She
was neither strong nor unwomanly, and she appears to have had
a flair for figuring in colourful and rather startling incidents.
Early in her Alpine career she climbed Mont Blanc with two
guides and Madame Sylvain-Couttet, the wife of one of them.
Then the party drank the customary bumper of champagne,
following which the four danced a quadrille in the bright sun
and sang the "Marseillaise", a banned song in those days of the
Second Empire.She was a woman ofimmense vitality, and a typical picture of
her is given by John Stogdon, a mountaineer who gave up plans
for Himalayan exploring when he married. Coolidge was study-
ing at the Bel Alp and Miss Brevoort was invited to join a party
that included Stogdon and the Rev. Arthur Fairbanks.
V.M. 12 l8l
Her courage and exuberant enjoyment doubled our pleasure [he
recalled years later]. She was ready for anything. One crevasse,
of which we could see no end, was too broad for her to jump, but
she jumped at my rash proposal that we should let her down into it
till she could find a ledge to stand on. We paid her out some forty
feet, but I thought we should never have got her up again. Youcan't get a direct pull. However, in spite of cut knuckles, she
thoroughly enjoyed it.
It was a tragedy of Miss Brevoort's life that her two greatest
Alpine ambitions were both frustrated. One of these was to be
the first woman to ascend the Matterhorn, a feat for which she
had everything ready in 1871, having unsuccessfully attemptedthe mountain from the Italian side in 1869. One of her guides
incautiously mentioned the plans to Melchior Anderegg who
immediately hurried off to Zermatt, as loyalty bade him, where
he knew that the Walkers could be found. Plans were quickly
formed, and on July 21 he led Lucy Walker, Francis Walker, her
father, and Frederick Gardiner, to the summit. Miss Brevoort,
arriving in Zermatt a few days later, was greeted with the news
that "the young lady has just come down from the Matterhorn".
Both women had nearly been preceded by Felicite Carrel,
daughter of an Italian guide not the great Carrel who four
years earlier had reached to within 350 ft. of the summit with a
party which climbed the Italian ridge.
Miss Brevoort, who a few days after the Walkers' ascent madethe first woman's traverse of the mountain by ascending from
Zermatt and descending the southern side into Italy, had one
ambition even stronger than that of making the first woman'sascent of the Matterhorn. She desired, possibly more than any-
thing else on earth, to be the first woman on top of the Meijein the Dauphine. Together with Coolidge, she had made the
first ascent of one of the lower peaks in 1870; and, with him,had gone back year after year, her hopes continually deferred
by bad weather.
In 1876 there came the chance of attempting the peak for
which she had mortgaged considerable emotional energy. She
gave it up so that Coolidge should have more money for climbing
182
in the Dauphine while she, her eyes on the expenses, remained
carefully in the Oberland. There was news that others had their
eyes on the Meije, then still unclimbed by either man or woman;Miss Brevoort's letter to Coolidge from the Oberland came
straight from the heart.
Alas, to think of all the others who will be coming, and of the
one who may succeed [she wrote]. Give my love to all my dear
old friends now in your sight and specially to that glorious Meijeand ask her to keep herself for me.
Within a few months of having written the letter, Miss
Brevoort was dead. Her nephew, hoping to make the first ascent
in her name, was preceded in 1877 by Boileau de Castelnau, a
young Frenchman. Coolidge made the second ascent the follow-
ing year, but it was not until 1888 that Kathleen Richardson, the
legendary Miss Richardson as the French called her, was to makethe first ascent of the peak by a lady.
Miss Richardson was the antithesis of the typical womanclimber of the period. Slender, short, looking rather like a pieceof carefully kept Dresden china, she was the most remarkable
of the women mountaineers who immediately followed Miss
Brevoort's generation. Brown-haired, green-eyed, frail-looking,
she was, in fact, tough and indefatigable. "She does not eat,
and she walks like a devil", the guides said of her.
She was on the Hornli at the age of sixteen and a few months
after her seventeenth birthday carried out her first campaign in
the Engadine, where she climbed the Piz Languard and the Piz
Corvatsch.
During the following eleven seasons she completed n6grandescourses and sixty minor ascents, six ofthem being first ascents by
any mountaineer, another fourteen of them first ascents by a
woman.The most remarkable of the first was her ascent ofthe Aiguille
de Bionnassay and the traverse of the East arte, a route often
attempted and considered impossible. Later in the same season
she heard that an Englishwoman whose name no one knew was
about to make the first ascent on the Meije. She hurried south to
183
the Dauphine, only to find that the Englishwoman was herself.
She justified die rumour that had gone before her, climbing the
mountain in a single day from La Berarde.
Many ofMiss Richardson's climbs were made with Mile Mary
Paillon, the famous French Alpinist who nearly killed her com-
panion on the Central Aiguille d'Arves when the Frenchwoman's
skirts dislodged a stone which crashed down on Miss Richardson's
head. When the couple were within a few yards of the summit,
Miss Richardson, having changed places with her friend, waited
for Mile Paillon to reach her, then pushed her ahead with the
words. "You go first. I have the Meije. You take the Aiguille
d'Arves."
By Miss Richardson's day, women climbers had become
increasingly numerous. One of the most remarkable amongthem was the woman who is most generally remembered as
Mrs. Aubrey le Blond.
Born of a wealthy Irish family, she first visited Switzerland
because ofher poor health, was attracted by the mountains, made
the ascent of Mont Blanc almost by accident, and showed her
attitude when she later wrote that she owed "a supreme debt of
gratitude to the mountains for knocking from me the shackles
of conventionality".
For years she thought it only right that she should travel in
the mountains with her ladies' maid. Only when one had eloped
with a courier and another developed hysteria whenever her
mistress was late in returning from a climb, did she dispense with
such women.
Her importance was that she took it for granted that womenshould climb, and should do so on equal terms with men. WhenRoman Imboden, the son ofher favourite guide, and a man with
whom she had frequently climbed, was killed in the Alps, she
felt compelled to give up mountaineering in the Alps; habit was
too much, however, and for season after season she visited
Norway, making there a series of first ascents almost comparableto that of Cecil Slingsby.
Like Maud Meyer, Maths Tutor at Girton and a later President
of the Ladies' Alpine Club which Mrs. Le Blond helped to found,
184
she represented the last struggle of the Victorian woman climber
freeing herself from the prejudice of the past; like Maud Meyer,her remarkable record carried on not only into the Edwardian
but into the Georgian era.
Both women are symbols of the triumph achieved whenwomen on the mountains were first judged equally with menMiss Meyer met, and was apparently unrebuked by, Sir W. E.
Davidson who had so criticised the Pigeons. Both womenshowed by the multiplicity of their interests, by their courage,and by their devoted interest in mountains through years ofhard
work, a reflection of the earlier Victorian male mountaineers
whom they resemble so much.
Mrs. Le Blond did not die until 1934, leaving behind her a
memory of tremendous accomplishments and more than half a
dozen books in which she exhorted her fellows up into the
mountains.
Miss Meyer, whose record included more than a hundred
expeditions each of them neatly recorded in an edition of
Coolidge's Alps in Nature and History continued climbing highmountains until eighteen months before her death at the age of
sixty-one.
Her death was in keeping.
For some years she had been bicycling all over London to her
various mathematical coaching appointments [says a surviving
relative]. Everybody warned her of the dangers of this procedure,at her age, and in London's growing traffic. She replied that she
liked it, that it kept her fit, and there was a spice ofexcitement about
it; if she got killed, it was entirely her responsibility, and you mightas well die that way as any other.
She did.
185
Chapter Nine
THE MOUNTAINEERS IN BRITAIN
Far me this land, that sea, these airs, those folk andfields suffice.
What purple Southern pomp can match our changeful Northern
skies,
Black with December snows unshed or pearled with August haze
The clanging arch ofsteel-grey March, orJune 's long-lighted days?
KIPLING
ITwas in the i88o's that the activities of Cecil Slingsby and
of a small handful of other enthusiasts began to form the
corpus of knowledge and tradition around which climbing in
Britain was to grow.Men had, of course, found pleasure on the British hills before
the Victorian Alpinists devoted themselves to the matter. The
Highland Mountain Club ofLochgoilhead, which held its annual
meetings on Midsummer Day to climb a local hill and to carry
on there "certain festivities", was founded in 1815. The Gaiter
Club, which in 1911 offered financial help to the Scottish
Mountaineering Club for the publication of its guide-books, had
been founded by the then Lord Inverclyde in 1849. The Cobbler
Club, the first club in Britain whose main purpose was the
encouragement of mountain-climbing, was founded in Glasgowin 1866 for those who wanted "to climb the Cobbler and what-
ever other worthy hill can be reached in the course of a Saturday
expedition from Glasgow". The Perthshire Mountain Club,
started in 1875 as a section of the Perthshire Society of Natural
History, initiated its members with due ceremony at the top of
a 3,ooo-footer whose ascent was the qualification for entry, and
utilised the services of a cairn-master and of a bard who recited
a specially written poem.South of the Border, there came Mathews' "Society of Welsh
186
Rabbits" and, later, the Yorkshire Ramblers' Club in whose
formation Cecil Slingsby played such a prominent part. All
these clubs, and the others which sprang up in the 1890'$, were
the crystallisation of a process which had begun in the middle of
the century, when the enthusiasm of the earlier Alpine climbers,
taking a casual week-end in North Wales or the Lakes, had begunto act upon the local fell-walkers.
The Queen herself was not without influence. A poor view
is generally taken of her reaction to mountain-climbing, but it
is not true that after the Matterhorn accident she attempted to
have climbing forbidden; she merely made a note of the fact in
her diary "four poor Englishmen including a brother of Lord
Queensberry have lost their lives in Switzerland, descendingover a dangerous place from the Matterhorn and falling over a
precipice". It was only after three serious accidents in the summerof 1882 that she made any move.
Then on August 24, 1882, Sir Henry Ponsonby, her private
secretary, wrote to Mr. Gladstone.
The Queen [he said] commands me to ask you if you think
she can say anything to mark her disapproval of the dangerous
Alpine excursions which this year have occasioned so much loss
of life.
Gladstone, who appears to have been on the side of the angels,
suggested that no action be taken.
I do not wonder Pie said] that the Queen's sympathetic feelings
have again been excited by the accidents, so grave in character,
and so accumulated during recent weeks, on the Alps. But I doubt
the possibility of any interference, even by her Majesty, with a
prospect of advantage. It may he questionable whether, upon the
whole, mountain-climbing (and be it remembered that Snowdonhas its victims as well as the Matterhorn) is more destructive
than various other pursuits in the way of recreation which per-
haps have no justification to plead so respectable as that which
may be alleged on behalf of mountain expeditions. The question,
however, is not one of wisdom or unwisdom; but viewing it, as
you put it, upon its very definite and simple grounds, I see no
room for action.
Yet these comments were not made known at the time. For
the mass of mankind, the Queen was the monarch who had
commanded a special performance of Albert Smith's "Mont
Blanc", who had fallen in love with the Cairngorms, had ascended
Lochnagar and many other peaks surrounding Balmoral on
pony, it is true and had later shown by her Leaves from AJournal of Our Life in the Highlands that she had a genuine
delight in the glories of the mountains. She allowed Prince
Arthur, Duke of Connaught, to reach the Grands Mulets on
Mont Blanc in 1864, even though she did not allow him to con-
tinue to the summit and become the youngest person he was
then 14 who had attained it. Little of this was "mountaineer-
ing", yet it did make more understandable in the public mind the
growing association between the "Alpinists" and the local fell-
walkers.
Many ofthese fell-walkers and hill-wanderers were formidable
men. There was, for instance, that queer unidentified figure
after whom was named the Parson's Nose, the fine rock-snout
that thrusts itself out into Cwm Glas.
This clergyman described by John Henry Clifie was, he
says,
possessed of a most extraordinary mania for climbing mountains.
Picture to yourself a tall man, about 52 years of age, ofa wiry, spare
habit, rather slightly built, dressed in a pair of dingy slop trousers,
a linen spencer of the same complexion, without hat or covering of
any sort for the head, no neck-tie, his shirt-collar unbuttoned, with
an enormous alpenstock or climbing pole, seven or eight feet in
length, in his hand, and you may perhaps be able to form some idea
of the strange grotesque figure we have endeavoured to describe.
His object was, to use his own expression, "to follow the skyline",until he reached the summit; he would then descend the other side
of the mountain towards Beddgelert, in a similar manner. He most
frequently performed his excursions alone, although occasionally,when not so familiar with the locality, he availed himself of the
services ofa guide. He would follow up these rambles de die in diem,
regardless of the weather, and was generally on his legs from about
nine a.m. until eight p.m. The most extraordinary thing was, howhe could keep up such violent daily exercise without any refreshment
188
35 Cecil Slingsby, in 1876, at the age of 27
whatever during the period he was among the mountains. To pre-vent thirst, he carried a small pebble in his mouth; and Harry Owen,the guide, assured us that he never saw him partake of anything to
eat or drink, not even a cup of cold water, while on an excursion.
We have several times met him on his return to the inn (Pen-y-
Gwryd), drenched with perspiration, and whilst his dinner was being
prepared, he would continue at gentle exercise (staff in hand), to
"cool down" like a race-horse after a "breather" preparatoryto partaking of his repast in fine weather generally al fresco
exhibiting not the least apparent fatigue. He was a man of very
temperate habits; two or three glasses of sherry were the extent of
his libations; he avoided smoking and he would be up early
in the morning performing his ablutions for several hours. He
appeared to have no other object in climbing to the wild moun-
tain-tops than merely (as he said) to behold the wonderful works
of the Almighty.
What the cHmbing parson was to Wales, Frederick Bowringwas to the Lakes. Both men broke away from the tradition of
making only certain set and "popular" ascents although Bowringclimbed Great Gable more than a hundred times and both
provided a nucleus ofnon-professional local knowledge on which
the Alpine Club men of the sixties and seventies could draw.
Bowring, who was born in 1823 and did not die until 1918,
must have been as striking a figure as the climbing parson. And,
like him, Bowring climbed and walked with great vigour and
precision when he was nearing the age of sixty.
His long legs were clad in thick trousers; his fine head (which
strikingly resembled that of the poet Tennyson) was covered with a
felt hat, the wide brim of which had been reduced to limpness byhis habit of securing it in windy weather by means of an immense
blue kerchief tied under his chin. The "Norfolk" jacket was too
modern for him and his usual coat bore somewhat bunchy tails with
huge pockets which contained, as a minimum, maps, compass,
string, field-glasses, sandwiches, and the afore-mentioned blue
bandana, gloves, a large grey woollen comforter, and several books,
besides abundant materials for smoking. In his hand was a stout
six-foot fell-pole with a forked spike, which he thought less liable to
slip on rocks.
V.M. 13 191
The third, and possibly the most eccentric of all these earlyfell-walkers was the Rev. James Jackson. A tall, bearded char-
acter who had served with the British forces during the early
Napoleonic wars and then, relinquishing this career for the
Church, he had served in a variety of incumbencies throughoutthe North of England, and astounded his congregations almost
as much by his egotistical verses as by his prodigious feats of
walking.In his sixty-ninth year, he walked forty-six miles in fourteen
and a half hours, followed this up two days later with fifty-six
miles in eighteen hours, and, after another two days, with sixty
miles in less than twenty hours.
His character is best shown by the incident of the weather-cock
on his church steeple at Rivington. When steeplejacks refused
to go up to it to carry out a repair, Jackson himself swarmed upthe spire and commemorated the incident with a ditty which
went:
Who has not heard of Steeple JackThat lion-hearted Saxon?
Though I'm not he, he was my sire
For I am SteepleJackson!
He became one of the most persistent fell-ramblers and
-scramblers, although for years he believed that the Pillar was
inaccessible. Then he read an account in a local paper of howthe Westmorland brothers and their sister Kate had climbed
to the top. This was too much for Steeple Jackson, even
though he was then seventy-nine. Thus, on May 31, 1875, he
clambered to the top alone, carrying a rope and wearingnailed shoes. Arrived on the summit, he deposited the re-
ligious relics he had brought home from Loretto a Victorian
version of the contemporary crosses on Alpine peaks andrecorded his ascent in a Greek inscription which he proudlydescribed as "written without specs". He immediately dubbedhimself the "Patriarch of the Pillarites", nominated a friend
as "Patriarch Presumptive", and commemorated the event
thus:
192
If this in your mind you will fixWhen I make the Pillar my toy,
I was born in 19 7, p, 6,
And you'll think me a nimble old boy.
When he was eighty-two, he set out with the intention of
making his second ascent of the Pillar; after two days' absence,
he was found in Great Doup, the hollow near by, having apparentlymistaken his position in the mist and plunged 300 ft. to his death.
On a piece ofpaper in his pocket, carefully wrapped and put into
a bottle which he had planned to leave on the summit, were his
last lines:
Two elephantine properties are mine
For I can bend to pick up pin or plack:
And when this year the Pillar Rock I climb
Four score and two's the howdah on my back.
Judged by modern standards, Jackson was merely a rather
incautious scrambler. Yet it was just such men who helped to
acquire the considerable body ofknowledge which was available
by the i88o's; knowledge used by those men with experience of
the Alps who during ruminating strolls on the hills cast enquiring
glances at the gullies which might, in heavy snow, provide them
with a few hundred feet of sport.
Charles Packe, that pioneer of the Pyrenees and the author of
a guide to the range that is still so readable, was scrambling about
the Lakeland fells invariably with his Pyrenean mountain dogsas early as 1850 and a few years later was camping and sleeping-
out on them in his home-designed sleeping-bags. In the late
1850*5, he introducedJohn Ball, Hinchliff, and William Longmanto both the Lakeland fells and the hills of North Wales, and his
rambling and scrambling tours continued for fifty years until
within a few years of his death at the age of seventy.Leslie Stephen, the Rev. Julius Elliott, who made the second
ascent of the Matterhorn from Zermatt before being killed on the
Schreckhorn by an unwary and unroped jump, and C. A. O.
Baumgartner, are only three of the many climbers from the
Alps who made early ascents ofthe Pillar Rock. Stephen climbed
193
wherever and whenever he could, and there is at least one record
of him, gangling and prehensile, ascending a chimney near
Gurnard's Head, on those granite cliff-faces to which the Climbers'
Club have recently issued a new guide-book.In Scotland it was such men as Horace Walker, veteran of the
famous first ascent of the Brenva Ridge of Mont Blanc, the
Pilkingtons, Norman Collie, Slingsby, and Solly, all of them
famous Alpine climbers, who were to make so many of the
pioneer ascents in Skye and on Ben Nevis.
In Wales, one finds Professor Tyndall, Macdonald, Moore,
Grove, and Tuckett among the regular week-enders. In 1879 an
Alpine Club meeting was held at Capel Curig, in North Wales,
while the following year no less than twenty Alpine Club mem-bers accompanied by one of the most famous lady mountaineers
of the time, made the first ascent of Gust's Gully on Great End
in the Lakes.
These enthusiasts from the Alps who gradually took over from
the "local men" found, as the Badminton volume on "Moun-
taineering" later put it, that "the British hills afford endless
opportunities for the gratification of our climbing instincts and
for the cultivation of all those faculties, habits, and virtues,
which collectively form the art of mountaineering".The revelation came slowly, over a period ofyears, and would
have come more slowly still had it not been for an article which
Professor Tyndall contributed to the Saturday Review in 1861.
Tainted by the city air [he wrote] and with gases not natural to
the atmosphere of London, I gladly chimed in with the proposalof an experienced friend to live four clear days at Christmas onWelsh mutton and mountain air.
He arrived at Bethesda with Professor Huxley and Mr. Busk,and after the party had bought rake-handles at fourpence each
and had converted them into alpenstocks, they finally reached
Capel Curig, The following morning they set out for Snowdon,three middle-aged gentlemen, tramping through the thick snowon what must have appeared in those days a rather crazyChristmas adventure.
194
Tyndall was at this time an experienced mountaineer. Not
only had he ascended Mont Blanc three times, but he had reached
13,000 ft. on the Matterhorn (the highest point then gained) andhad earned a reputation among the Alpine fraternity for a daringthat hardly matched the slow-dying view sternly supported byTyndall himself that men climbed mountains merely to carryout scientific observations.
Yet the man's enthusiasm was kindled by the Welsh hills justas it had been in the Alps. On the summit of Snowdon, the viewhe said, "would bear comparison with the splendours of the
Alps themselves". Here was enthusiasm for the British hills
which would have sounded extravagant from any climber ofthose days, let alone from the dispassionate Tyndall. The result,
not so much of this article itself, but of the interest which it
aroused, was a steady growth of climbing, in England, Scotland,
and Wales, by men from the Alps who even a few years earlier
would have scorned the suggestion that Britain contained
anything comparable to the Alps.
From the i88o's onwards, there was apparent a subtle but
significant change in the records, interests, and ideals of the mento be found climbing in Britain.
There were some, such as Slingsby or Hastings or Solly, who
appeared to devote almost as much time and attention to the
Lakes, to Wales, or to Scotland, as they did to the mountains
abroad. There was an increasing influx of young men, such as
Haskett-Smith, who climbed in Britain for a number of seasons
before visiting the Alps at all. And there finally developed such
climbers as Archer-Thomson and O. G. Jones who went abroad
only rarely and whose main interest was concentrated on the
climbing, mainly rock-climbing as opposed to snow- and ice-
work, which was to be found on the British crags.
Simultaneously, there is to be sensed a change of emphasis in
the reasons for which most men went mountaineering. As
climbing in Britain became more surely divorced from climbingin the Alps during the last quarter of the century, so did the
basic reasons which drove men up into the hills become more
divorced from the weighty problems that had troubled the
195
thinkers of a decade or so earlier. Trevelyan's comment that
"all the thought of the age arose out of the circumstances of the
age" is no less true of the second than it was of the first half of
the Victorian era. And, by the i88o's, matters both temporaland spiritual were far easier than they had been two decades
earlier. There might still be worries about the problems posed
by the scientists, but the first awful impact ofDarwin had passed,
and the Church had, as it were, got its second breath. Materially,
the most extravagant dreams of the optimists had been more than
realised; there had been no revolution; and, even if the national
cake still failed to provide every British worker with all that he
wanted, yet there seemed little reason to believe that this happystate was not round a nearby corner.
There is no particular reason to link these two developmentsof the i88o's the growth of British mountaineering and the
decrease in importance ofthose spiritual problems that epitomisedthe Victorian hey-day. There is no reason to believe that the
British hills gave something less necessary than that exultation
given by the Alps to Frederic Harrison when he wrote in praise
of Alpine climbing: "We need sometimes that poetry should be
not droned into our ears, but flashed into our senses." Yet it is
a fact that the problems decreased; and that, simultaneously, those
men who might have been driven to the Alps did find in the
British hills some satisfaction similar to that which the earlier
climbers had found in the Alps and in such greater ranges as
they later visited.
Typical of the transition period during which the rambles of
the fell-walkers were being replaced by the more ambitious
adventures ofthe experienced Alpinists, wasJohn Wilson Robin-
son, a dour Keswick estate agent, the son of a great fell-walker
who had sketched the Napes Needle as early as 1828.
Robinson himself did not start climbing until 1882, when he
made his first ascent of the Pillar, and it was about the same
year that he first met Haskett-Smith, the young lawyer who
played the most important part of all in the developmentof climbing in Britain during the latter quarter of the last
century.
196
To the combination, Robinson brought his great local know-ledge, gained not only during his walks on the fells, but duringthe day-to-day routine of his business. Even when one considershis luck in living so close to the hills, and his vigour he oncewalked over the
principal summits of the Lakes, a total ofseventymiles, in twenty-four hours the amount of climbing that heaccomplished was
astonishing. He ascended the Pillar 101 timesbetween 1882 and 1906, taking between thirty and forty ladiesto the top during this period, and also made more than fiftyascents of Scawfell Pinnacle, while between 1877 and 1903 hemade nearly forty ascents of Great Gable.
Just as Coolidge was uninterested in any range other than the
Alps, so was Robinson completely disinterested in the Alps or
any other range outside Britain. He made one visit to the Alps,climbed the Matterhorn, which impressed him in a routine way,and thereafter concentrated solely on climbing in Britain.
Robinson's most constant companion in Britain was W. P.
Haskett-Smith, "the father of British mountaineering", a manfor whom the Alps and the Pyrenees, the latter ofwhich he knewwell, were but faint shadows of his own well-loved Lakelandfells.
Haskett-Smith stares from the portrait of the early climbingdays slightly quizzically and rather defiantly, two attitudes
which combined with his phenomenal list of first ascents to
give him such a place in the story of British climbing. Born in
1859, he had a neat trim record typical of the times Eton,
Trinity, and Lincoln's Inn. Thereafter he departed from the
conventions. He did not practise at the Bar, and WinthropYoung says that his only serious quarrel was when a fellow-
member of the Alpine Club, thinking he was bestowing a
favour, sent him a brief. He interested himself in the moreabstruse aspects of philology, pottered around in a genial way,and became, like Coolidge, one of those rare things, a legend in
his own lifetime.
His first visit to the British mountains was in 1882 when he
spent nine weeks at Wasdale Head in the Lakes, explored DeepGhyll, made the first ascent of Pavey Ark Gully, found a new
197
high-level traverse across the north face of Great Gable, and
explored the whole area for climbable routes without, it should
be noted, having had any more experience of mountains or
mountaineering than had been gained from a stroll through the
Pyrenees with Charles Packe during the previous year.
In 1 884 he returned to the Lakes and continued his explorations
there as he was to do, year after year, until the turn ofthe century.
"Of course", he adds in what is a revealing comment on the
period, "no ropes or other illegitimate means were resorted to."
He pioneered first ascents of Scawfell, on Great Gable, Doe Crag,on the Napes Ridges, and on most other areas of rock which
are today laced with routes.
It is, however, with the Napes Needle, the slender and spec-
tacular pillar of rock standing out from the Napes Ridges, that
Haskett-Smith is most intimately connected. He has described
in an early number of the Journal of the Fell and Rock Climbing
Club of Great Britain, how he came to make the historic first
ascent. He had seen the Needle first on a misty day in the early
i88o's, "a slender pinnacle of rock, standing out against the back-
ground of cloud without a sign of any other rock near it, and
appearing to shoot up for 200-300 ft."
It was not until 1886, however, that he found himself alone,
and in the late afternoon, in the gap which separates the
Needle from the ridges which rise up die face of the mountain
behind it.
My first care [Haskett-Smith wrote later] was to get two or three
stones and test the flatness ofthe summit by seeing whether anythingthrown up could be induced to lodge. If it did, that would be an
indication of a moderately flat top, and would hold out hopes of
the edge being found not too much rounded to afford a good gripfor the fingers. Out of three missiles, one consented to stay, and
thereby encouraged me to start, feeling as small as a mouse climbinga milestone.
Between the upper and lower blocks, about five feet up, there is
a ragged horizontal chink large enough to admit the toes, but the
trouble is to raise the body without intermediate footholds. It
seemed best to work up at the extreme right, where the corner
198
fi
.
Q.3
fcO
3S
40 The "Stable-door Traverse"
at Wastdale Head
41 W. P. Haskett-Sniitli in his early
climbing days
projects a little, though the fact that you are hanging over the deepgap makes it a rather "nervy*' proceeding. For anyone in a standing
position at the corner it is easy to shuffle the feet sideways to the
other end of the chink, where it is found that the side of the topblock facing outwards is decidedly less vertical. Moreover at the
foot of this side there appeared to my great joy a protuberance
which, being covered with a lichenous growth, looked as if it might
prove slippery, but was placed in the precise spot where it wouldbe most useful in shortening the formidable stretch up to the top
edge. Gently and cautiously transferring my weight, 1 reached upwith my right hand and at last was able to feel the edge and proveit to be, not smooth and rounded as it might have been, but a flat
and satisfactory grip. My first thought on reaching the top was one
of regret that my friends should have missed by a few hours such a
day's climbing, three new things and all good [he had just madethe first ascent of the Ennerdale face of Great Gable and the first
continuous descent of the Needle Ridge]; my next was one of
wonder whether getting down again would not prove far more
awkward than getting up.
Hanging by the hands, and feeling with the toes for the pro-tuberance provided an anxious moment, but die rest went easily
enough, though it must be confessed that it was an undoubted
satisfaction to stand once more on solid ground below and look upat my handkerchief fluttering in the breeze.
The Needle was not climbed again for three years and then
three ascents were made within a few months. A lady, Miss
Koecher, climbed it in 1890, and a few months later an illustrated
article on the Needle appeared in the Pall Mall Gazette.
The fame of the spectacular spire of rock, the most photogenic
in the country, soon spread. Spooner, the well-known photo-
grapher in the Strand, displayed a photograph of it in his shop
window, and it was here that it first illustrated to O. G. Jones,
a typical specimen of the second generation of British climbers,
the possibilitiesoffered by British mountains and hills.
In 1890 Jones, a technical student in London at the time, had
visited the Lakes on a walking-tour and climbed the Pillar with
no more knowledge of mountaineering than could be gleaned
from the pages of Prior's Guide, a chatty little book that broke
V.M. 14 201
new ground by giving its readers some indication of the area's
rock features.
The following year, walking down the Strand in London,
oppressed with the flatness of people and things in general as
he puts it, Jones glanced in Spooner's window, and for the first
time, saw the outline of the Needle. Bystanders, he noted,
looked at the tiny figures of climbers in the photograph and
passed the usual uninformed remarks. "That evening", adds
Jones, "a copy of the Needle hung in my room; in a fortnight,
Easter had come round and I found myself on the top of the
pinnacle."
Such was a typical result of Haskett-Smith's discovery. The
photograph of the Needle which was itself later taken as the
emblem of the Fell and Rock Climbing Club became a symbolof the new adventures to be found not beyond the Channel but
in Britain itself. Today there are seven "regular" routes up the
Needle, but the magic of its outline still holds. Perhaps the most
moving day in its history came in 1936 when Haskett-Smith,
then seventy-four, made his anniversary ascent, being led up to
the summit by Lord Chorley, then President ofthe Fell and Rock,before an admiring audience ofmany hundreds ranged around the
Dress Circle, the rocky bay on the Napes from which the Needle
stands out in all its apparent inaccessibility.
As Haskett-Smith sat down on the uppermost block, a voice
from the crowd below urged him to "Tell us a story." "There is
no other story. This is the top storey", he immediately shouted
back, a typical response from a man who devoted much of his
life to the curiosities of words, to outlandish facts, and to useless
but interesting branches of knowledge.He climbed in Scotland and Wales, in the Pyrenees, the Alps,
Norway, Spain, the Rockies, and even the Andes, but all his
enjoyment and all his important climbing was concentrated onthe Lakes.
Haskett-Smith not only "created" climbing in Britain; he also
took the first step in its popularisation, and he would be of
importance in the gradual expansion of mountaineering towards
the end of the century if he had done nothing more than write
202
and have published the two slim red-backed volumes of Climbingin the British Isles.
When the first of Haskett-Smith's volumes appeared in 1894,climbers had been describing their Alpine exploits in print for
nearly half a century. Ball's Alpine Guide was merely one of the
short cuts to Alpinism that had been making the way even easier
for young men wishing to take up climbing. It is true that there
had been, as there still is, a feeling that the more reckless expedi-tions should not be given too bright a limelight; yet so far as the
great majority of new expeditions and ascents were concerned
they had been, since the early i88o's, recorded either in the Alpine
Journal or in one of the many records of private exploration that
were published, if privately, at least in sufficient numbers to fill
the demand.
The position of British rock-climbing intelligence was a little
different. Virtually no printed information had appeared in 1884when two articles on the subject were published in All the Year
Round. The first climbers' log-book had appeared at Wastdale
Head only four years earlier. Haskett-Smith's were therefore the
first to break the unwritten law that accounts of climbs in
Britain should be passed down only by word of mouth so that
information would be graded according to the experience of
the recipient.
This state of affairs was a happy, but impermanent, one. "For
some years past", said Haskett-Smith in his preface, "there has
been a remarkably rapid increase in the number of men whoclimb for climbing's sake within the bounds of the British Isles."
It was for them that the little red-bound books were intended, a
primer for the embryonic mountaineers who might otherwise
"have missed their vocation because they were in the position of
the prudent individual who would not go into the water until
after he had learned to swim".
Mere numbers alone are no index of the influence exerted byHaskett-Smith's guides after their quiet explosion on the Victorian
scene. Between their publication and the mid-193 o's, in fact,
they sold only some 3,000 copies each, a striking comparison
with the 120,000 copies of the late J. E. Q. Barford's Climbing in
203
Britain which were sold within a few years of its publication
roughly half a century later. Yet it is not too much to claim
that "Haskett-Smith" opened the floodgates which the pioneers
had slowly begun to move. The volumes paved the way for
CX G, Jones' more detailed Climbing in the English Lake District,
for the lavishly illustrated volumes of the Abraham brothers and,
ultimately, for the whole shelf-loads of detailed climbing-guides
which today deal with the most minor routes up the most
inconspicuous boulders. Some of these have continued the
tradition of mild humour with which Haskett-Smith laced
most of his descriptions; none have contained such a wealth
of detail about the less technical but more human aspects of
the sport.
The publication of "Haskett-Smith'' underlined the fact that
climbing in Britain now existed as a sport in its own right, as
something distinct from, and not necessarily linked with, climbingin the Alps or elsewhere. It was a sport which grew enormouslyas the century drew to its close and which was different in two
important ways from mountaineering as it had been thought of
and practised during the previous half-century.
The relative nearness of the mountains to the climbers' homes
had two major results. In the first place, the hills lost somethingof their mystery. The mountains at the end of the street could
never be quite the same as the mountains which lay beyond the
sea, in a foreign land where they still posed topographical
problems even though the solution of these was no longerhindered by the presence of dragons.Almost as important was the fact that climbers living so
relatively close to the mountains could, by constant practise,
achieve a proficiency impossible for those whose climbing was
limited to a few weeks or perhaps months every year. Thusthe climbers on British hills towards the end of the century-
began, on rocks at least, to approach that technical efficiency
which had previously been die prerogative of the Alpine
guide.
By the turn of the century mountaineering in Britain, the
off-shoot of Victorian Alpinism, had grown into a lusty plant,
204
An off-shoot it was, however. Many of the basic factors which
brought about the growth of mountaineering in the fifties and
sixties still existed. Their presence, grim and challenging, is
shown most clearly by that epitome of all later Victorians,
Martin Conway, later Lord Conway of Allington.
205
Chapter Ten
CONWAY, THE VICTORIANMOUNTAINEERFrom too much love ofliving,
Fromfear and hope setfree',
We thank ivith briefthanksgiving
Whatever Gods may be
That nolife
livesfor ever;
That dead men rise up never;
That even the weariest river
Winds somewhere safe to sea.
SWINBURNE
AMONG the mountaineers and mountain-lovers of the
jLJL nineteenth century there had been many for whom the
beauty of the heights had been one of the main, if one of the
most elusive, attractions offered by the Alps. Ruskin had been
the most prominent of them but there had also been Elizah
Walton, E. T. Coleman, George Barnard, and H. G. Willink.
Yet it was not until Conway arrived upon the scene with the
full flourish of a connoisseur's knowledge that an active moun-
taineer, well versed in the craft, with all the minutiae of the
sport at his finger-tips, and in his pocket the money to indulge
it, was to approach the Alps with what was basically an artist's
outlook.
Just as the earlier mountaineers had subordinated all else to the
process of getting their instruments in the right place at the righttime creating only incidentally the craft of travel above the
snowline so did Conway plan much of his mountaineeringlife in order that the exquisite mountain view, the panoramaseen, as the pioneers had seen it, with eyes of wonder, the unique
ridge viewed end-on with peculiar perspective, should separatelyor together form a part of each day's journeying. From his
206
writings there comes the same impression; the feeling that an
important part of each expedition was in fact a search for somene;/ facet of the Alpine world which could be viewed with the
eyes not only of the climber but of the artist. There is nothing
quite like it, and few things so good, in the whole of Alpineliterature.
There were many factors which combined to ease WilliamMartin Conway, later Lord Conway of Allington, into the
enviable position which he enjoyed throughout the last quarterof the nineteenth century. Born in 1856, he came of age after
the first great mountain problems had been solved; he could,
therefore, devote himself to those in which history, topography,or art, as well as pure conquest, played their respective parts. Hewas lucky in his parents, and in his position in life, and it is easyto claim that the more obviously inherited features of his life
were responsible for his success. This is not entirely true.
It would be fair to say that everything Conway touched
turned, if not to gold yet at least to a not unprofitable venture.
It is true that he can have seen little financial profit from some
of his larger expeditions, but he had a background to cushion
him against such occasional and minor matters. There were few
amateurs of the period who could plan, as Conway planned, to
employ another amateur the late Oscar Eckenstein as a
professional guide on a lengthy journey to India. He could
write, with no offence, of "my artist", A. D. MacCormick, who
accompanied him to the Himalayas and illustrated a number of
his books. His planning of an expedition to the most distant
ranges of the world was usually a question not of money but
of time; and when his plan for a whole series of climbing guides
had been rejected by the Alpine Club he was quite prepared to
embark on the task himself, virtually underwriting whatever loss
might ensue. It was perhaps significant that when, as a child, he
reached the top of Snowdon for the first time and found himself
too small to add a stone to the cairn, his cousin's butler did so
for him.
Yet happy financial circumstances would have been nothing
without the man himself. And, of all the Victorian mountaineers,
207
Martin Conway most nearly approached the Elizabethan ideal of
the "compleat man". His mind was the equal of his six-foot
stature: his humility to the confidence with which he would
tackle the most difficult or abstruse Alpine problem. An almost
medieval chivalry and other-worldliness appeared to govern his
life, and it was natural that in the untrodden mountains of distant
ranges he should see some challenge to the explainable facts of
life.
So far as mountains were concerned he was the incurable
Romantic, and it is not too much to claim that they ruled his
life just as surely as they ruled that of the Alpine guide.
Wide outspreading vistas, thank heaven, still retain for me the
same mysterious charm that belonged to that one [he wrote some
sixty years after having first seen the view from the Malvern
Beacon], The delusion that somewhere, far off in the blue distance,
lurks the Perfect Place, that the blue kills really are blue, that what
one beholds is in its essence actually as beautiful as from above it
seems so long as that delusion lasts, R.omance lingers.
And, like most of the Victorian climbers, he was tough. It is
"the cold air" which is "laden with the very spirit of romance".
He goes neither carefully nor cautiously and can write with real
relief of finding himself after some escapade as "suddenly in the
world of living people with a future to look forward to as well
as a past to remember".
Almost every aspect of the mountain world interested him.
One of the most important, an aspect which appears surprisingto anyone surveying the whole man, was the study of mountain
history and topography that by the later seventies was beginningto draw poor Coolidge ever more surely and irretrievably into
its clutches. Conway, however, always kept history in its placeas a servant.
He had made the ascent of the Breithorn in 1872, at the ageofsixteen but it was only in 1876, when he first visited the Enga-dine, that his serious climbing started. Thereafter, he returned to
the Alps year after year, climbing frequently either with GeorgeScriven, an Irish doctor whom he had known as a boy at Repton,or with Penhall who was later killed on the Wetterhorn.
208
3O2
D
u
to
E*rt
u
ZT3
.3
uo
New routes up previously climbed mountains were the order
of the day, and it was here that Conway, like many others, raninto difficulties. A hard day's work among the journals of the
various European Alpine Clubs was often needed to ensure that
a proposed "new" route had not, in fact, been climbed andrecorded in some obscure publication; even such checking and
cross-checking might not be conclusive. After two seasons at
Zermatt with Scriven, Conway records that "only once did weventure on a new way up Monte Rosa, which to our disgustafterwards proved to be not new but only unrecorded". It wasan error that Conway did not intend to repeat. He was then at
Trinity and on his return from the Alps set to work in the
University Library, intent on providing, at his own publishingcost ifneed be, a handy volume which would save climbers fromsimilar errors in the future.
He was only half-certain ofthe need for the book. He was only
twenty-four. He had been a member of the Alpine Club for
only three years, and it was natural that he would ask advice from
Coolidge, six years his senior and the newly appointed editor of
the Alpine Journal.His first lettqr to Coolidge, the vanguard of many hundreds
which were to pass between the two men during the next half-
century, summed up his doubts.
I have recently been constructing a small pocket-book for
mountaineers dealing with the Zermatt mountains [he said]. Do
you think that such a commodity is wanted? and do you approve of
the proposed flap-pocket-book form? It appears that the cost of
publication of 500 copies would be ^50, do you imagine that 500
people would turn up say in the next five years to whom such
a book would be a boon?
Coolidge lived for such requests. By return there went to
Conway a four-point list of comments, suggestions, a "liberal
order of copies", and an offer to read the proofs. As a result
there appeared in 1881 the record of ascents around Zermatt,
replete with a fine fund of historical information, all presented, in
the flap-pocket-book form, for a single half-crown the Zermatt
V.M. 15 211
Pocket-Book, that ancestor of all the dozens of little volumes in
whose pages one may today find the faces of the Alps cross-
hatched with routes, sub-routes, and demi-semi sub-routes. Even
at 2s. 6d., sales lagged. Four years after publication, more than
100 copies still remained in the hands of the publishers, although
when these had finally gone the second-hand price of the book
rose swiftly.
When the price of it rose to a pound, and I had acquired a great
deal of information, I decided to print a new edition [Conwaylater wrote]. That was issued in two parts, an East half and a West.
As I explained in the preface, that was done to make it necessary for
any climber to buy both parts. Moreover, as they had been willing
to pay a pound for a second-hand first edition, I decided that they
should pay me the same price for a much better and fuller book,
and they did.
The comment, typical as it is ofthe worldly-wise facade which
Conway habitually erected, does him less than justice. His
letters to Coolidge, hundred upon hundred ofthem, their writing
sandwiched between work as a prospective M.P., studies as a
rising art connoisseur, and a whole wealth of public and private
duties ("This is my 40th letter today", he says in the pre-type-
writer days. "I am nearly killed with piled-up details"), reflect
far more accurately the reasons for his continuing interest in the
guide. "The easy approaches ofecstatic enthusiasm were passed",
he explains. "The region of serious investigation and study had
now to be traversed." The continuing enquiry into Alpine
history was part of the traverse. Publication of the results was, if
nothing else, part of a scholar's duty.The Zermatt Pocket-Book, however, was only a beginning.
When preparing for its reissue, Conway had proposed to the
Alpine Club that they should allow him to publish it "as the
first part of an A.C. Guide to the High Alps". The Club,
probably with an eye on the republication of "Ball", rejectedthe scheme. Conway mulled over the idea with Coolidge and
between them they built up the skeleton of the series on which
they subsequently worked for years and which was published
212
as the Conway and Coolidge's Climbers' Guides. Only a publisherwas lacking.
T. Fisher Unwin, after suitable preparation by Conway, was
agreeable but cautious, as well as worried by the possible length,
unreadability, and general unmanageability of what might be
prepared in the way of copy. Coolidge's reputation had gonebefore him.
Conway, anxious that the first contact between Unwin and
Coolidge should take place with as little argument as possible,warned and advised his collaborator, in a letter marked "very
particularly and extremely and altogether especially private", of
the line that could best be taken.
Let TFU down lightly [he advised]. Don't threaten him, but
just send him your MS and he'll take it all right, especially if yousend him the short Lepontine Vol. first. Say you have borroweda few pages from that to add to the other as soon as he has put his
money into a volume or two we hold him. Don't forewarn Kim, of
prospective troubles, and in case of a longer volume than usual,
let him have the first part of the MS first and let that be in type
before he sees the last part or knows how long it will be. It's onlya question of management; if things get stiff at any time I will
ask TFU to lunch at the Savile, for election to which he is a
candidate.
As a gentle exercise in the art of twisting the arm, it was a
beautiful example, typical of the operation, extending over many
years, which was to give the Alpine world the volumes of the
Conway-Coolidge guides.
The story of the guides is in some ways a minor saga of
pedantic but academically justified argument on Coolidge's part,
of sweet reasonableness on Conway's. It was Conway who
finally had Coolidge's "honorarium" of five pounds per volume
doubled. It was Conway, "the buffer in the matter" as he
describes himself, who smoothed out the ferocious argument
that arose when Unwin proposed that one ofCoolidge's unwieldy,
over-annotated volumes should be splitinto two. Coolidge,
breathing blood and fire, was all for claiming that such a move
would break the publishing agreement and lay the way open for
213
legal action. Conway acted as mediator, pointed out that Unwincould not do the economically impossible, and finally persuaded
Coolidge to agree. Few men, incidentally, can have so little
justified Coolidge's idea of a grasping publisher as did Unwin.
"I doubt if the publication of these volumes will ever repay me",he wrote of another publishing proposal for mountain books,
"and yet I love the mountains so well that I am much interested
in them."
An astonishing amount of time, thought, and undiluted brain-
sweat was lavished on the Conway-Coolidge guides. The hun-
dreds ofletters dealing with each volume that passed between the
two men during the period of genesis form an indication ofjusthow much work was involved.
By the early nineties, however, Conway had already begun to
realise that while the mountains might satisfy all manner of
demands, the Alps themselves suggested something better in the
greater ranges beyond Europe. Short travels in Egypt, Syria,
Cyprus, Greece, and Turkey had awakened what even in later
life he called the romance of the East.
I found it wonderful [he says] to be in the midst of a people not
ashamed to acknowledge God by publicly praying wherever they
happened to be at the hour ofprayer, and performing their devotions
in those monumental attitudes wherewith Islam has endowed the
world.
Back in Britain, he was restless and dissatisfied, uneasy with a
desire that not all the excitement of his expanding public life
could fully satisfy. The outcome was his first great tour of
exploration, a journey that was to take him and his companions
higher than man had ever been before, deep into the heart of
the Karakoram, among the greatest glaciers of the world.
The plan had been roughly formed in 1890 and had matured
during the following year. Freshfield and Mummery, it was at
first intended, were to accompany Conway. Freshfield was
forced by circumstances to withdraw, while Conway and
Mummery realised, after a friendly pilot-run in the Graians, that
their ideas of mountain-climbing were so different as to preclude
214
any likelihood ofideal co-operation on a major enterprise. It wasa sensible decision and later events proved that a similar trial
between Conway and Oscar Eckenstein, who had been asked
tojoin the party and who was to have come in a semi-professional
capacity might have proved equally useful. As it was, difficulties
arose with Eckenstein, that queer friend of Aleister Crowley;and, as Conway says in his sole reference to Eckenstein in the
lengthy record of the expedition which he subsequently wrote,
"he did not come with me beyond Nagar", a point at which the
expedition had not truly begun.With him, on thisjourney to the Karakoram, Conway brought
A. D. MacCormick, the artist of the expedition, and Lt. Bruce,
one of the first men to believe that Everest could be climbed,
and as General Bruce the leader of the first full-scale expeditionto Everest in 1922. As guide, Conway had Matthias Zurbruggenof Macugnaga of whom he later wrote:
He was by nature ambitious of attainment. He desired to acquire
every sort of knowledge and every sort of skill that he could come
by. Ultimately, he could speak English, French, German, Italian,
a litde Spanish and (when in India), a smattering ofHindustani. Hewas also a competent blacksmith, a good carpenter, a useful all
round man with his hands, and a most accomplished craftsman with
axe and rope on the mountain-side. ... He was everlastingly picking
up information of one kind and another. I never knew a man with
a more hospitable mind, nor one better gifted by nature with the
potentialities of scholarship.
In hisown more rough-hewnway he musthavebeenuncommonlylike Conway himself.
The Royal Geographical Society, the Royal Society, and the
British Association, all contributed to the costs of the expedition
which as Conway ruefully admitted later were considerably
greater than had been expected. "Experience", he commented
on his return, "had to be purchased. Mine is at the service ofany
future traveller who chooses to apply for it."
The experience was considerable, for the expedition, in which
Conway was not only leader and organiser, but leading climber,
leading surveyor, and half a hundred other things, succeeded in
215
carrying out the first major reconnaissance of a great Asian
glacier. "What Freshfield did for the Caucasus, Conway did for
the Himalaya", it has been said. "He was the man who brought
the Himalaya to Europe."He surveyed the Hispar and Baltoro Glaciers. He unravelled
the intimate topography of a great knot of high mountains that
had not before been seen by Europeans. He reached the summit
of the 23,ooo-ft. Pioneer Peak, then the greatest height attained
by man. He won a knighthood for the work. He came back to
Britain perhaps more profoundly dissatisfied than ever, so near
had he been to finding what he sought.
Romance almost became a reality Pie writes of his experiences
in the great Biafo Valley]. The gods were very near at hand. Wetouched as it were the skirts of their garments. Yet even at the
culminating moments of these strenuous dream-days there still
lingered the sense of incompleteness, of something lacking. The
secret was almost disclosed, but never quite, the veil never entirely
withdrawn.
Back in Britain he took up the threads dropped by the successful
young man of independent means. He remained unsatisfied.
The restlessness grew throughout the months, and in 1894 he
embarked on a minor dream which had occupied many of his
thoughts throughout the long years of Alpine research with
Coolidge his traverse of the "Alps from End to End'*.
Conway had been, for many years, a violent and sometimes
unpopular protagonist of the ex-centrist theory of Alpinism. Hedid not believe that a man should settle down comfortably in an
Alpine hotel and then climb all the peaks within range. Climbingwas something different and more spiritually adventurous than
this for Conway. Every day had to mount up to a new prospectfor the morrow. Every day had to see not only an accomplish-
ment, but a new, opening-out vista whose prospect had lain
unrcvealed until the last possible moment. It was an almost
revolutionary idea, and certainly a good one in an age when the
Alps were, in the recurrent phrase, "played out".
In pursuing it, Conway had more than once tried to press on to
216
a reluctant Alpine Club his idea of a small select band, a clubwithin a club, an idea which he had once propounded to Coolidge.
I am going to read the Xmas paper to A.C. [he said}. I don'tknow about what, but I shall bring in my "Alpine Wanderers'Section of the A.C." proposal. To this end, I want the Alps divided
into groups, and no man should be allowed to join the A. Wandererswho had not climbed at least one mountain and crossed one pass in
at least one-quarter of the groups, and no one sd. be a life-member
who had not dittoed in at least f others to cease to be membersafter three non-wandering seasons. A peak to be at least 3,ooom,a pass 2,5oom unless special reasons for admitting a lower one.
No life-member to be able to qualify with less than 6 years of
wandering. The division into groups is not for scientific purposesbut intended to spread a man's travels. The area of each groupshould be traversed from end to end, a mere run into the edge of a
group and out again must not count.
Conway had divided the Alps into nearly thirty groups, and
through virtually all of them he passed during the journey he
began in the summer of 1894, and during which he was to climb
twenty-one peaks and thirty-nine passes with Zurbruggen, two
of the Ghurkas who had been with him in the Himalayas, and a
young climber called Edward Fitzgerald who accompanied the
party sporadically with his two guides.
Conway had had great ideas for Fitzgerald.
I have long thought [he wrote to Coolidge in 1893] that it would
be a good thing to get a young member of the Club into training
as an Alpine literature expert. I think I have found the man-Edward Fitzgerald. He is aged 22, newly married, a keen collector
and reader of Alpine books, has done several years climbing, is a
man of means and leisure, and wants to do something. ... I mean
to make him a kind of sub-editor of the "Alpine Journal" [he was
then in charge of the Journal], to receive and answer letters, etc.
I shall make him go and call on you at Oxford when you come
home and you will then be able to instill into him scholarly notions,
and see what you think ofhim. He is a very retiring, solitary person,
and might grow into a good editor if properly trained from the
start.
217
The suggestion was typical of Conway's good nature, of his
feeling for Alpine history, and of the careful way in which he
organised all his affairs. For Fitzgerald, it was a great opportunity.
He dropped it with both hands.
Conway's journey took him from the Col di Tenda at the
western end of the Alps to Monte Viso, Mont Blanc, the Nord-
end of Monte Rosa, the Jungfrau, the first ascent and passage
of what Conway gallantly named the Piz Ghurka and the
Gurkha Pass, and into Austria and the Gross Glockner and the
Ankogel.He returned to Britain, partially satisfied at least, unsuccessfully
contested Bath, and might well have been expected to settle downin enjoyment of his reputation. He had been knighted as a result
of his Himalayan journey ;he had a growing reputation as an art
connoisseur; he was the author of four books which had brought
him, ifno great financial reward, at least an enviable renown.
He was nearly forty. It might, his friends must have felt, have
been a wise thing to consolidate, to let the unknown rest in its
obscurity. Conway was not that sort of man.
I have never sought to be wise [he wrote later], but always to
plunge into the unknown, to get away from the dull round of
everyday and go forth as student or adventurer into subjects or
regions where it seems to me at the moment that the unattained
might be attainable, the unexperienced might be felt.
It was in this mood that he received a short contribution for
the Alpine Journal dealing with Spitzbergen. For most peoplethere was little lustre or romance or opportunity about the place.
For Conway, the unexpected article pointed the way. Perhaps
Spitzbergen might provide a different set of sensations, a different
collection of landscapes. Perhaps it might even be a country
where, in close contact with land, sea, and water, he might find
the answer to those problems which he was still seeking. Hecontinued to think of Spitzbergen. Then the vague ideas were
suddenly crystallised.
Early one morning [he says] I was riding along the bank of the
Serpentine in Hyde Park. It was misty and the water had been
218
U
45 Lord Conway of Allington
frozen over. The sheet of ice was broken up and the sun was
penetrating the mist andglittering on the ice. The tender evanescent
beauty of the scene took sudden possession of me. Thus, perhaps,on a grander scale, might arctic visions fashion themselves. At that
moment the fates decided for me the two expeditions carried out in
1896 and 1897.
On the first of these, Conway made the pioneer crossing of
Spitsbergen; on the second he made the first ascent of a numberof peaks; on both he added immeasurably to the knowledge ofa virtually unknown and unmapped country one-third the size
of the whole British Isles. He did more than add to knowledge,however. Conway had the facility for recording and interpretinghis knowledge so that it was readily understandable to the non-
technical mind; he had a unique facility for taking descriptive
writing to the nearest possible fringe of the purple patch; and he
had an enthusiasm for all that he did that bubbled over into his
writing. In one important way, he differed from most of the
other climbers of his period; he evinced no wish to convert. Hewas not, like most of them, trying to exhort his readers up into
the mountains. Reading Conway one has the impression of a
man entranced with all that he saw and translating the vision,
almost by accident, into such a form that all other men mightunderstand it.
There is his description of an evening when the final crossing
of Spitzbergen was still in the balance.
Climbing the hill above camp the moment it was pitched, I rose
above the ice-wall which proved to be the side of the snout of a
great glacier [he says]. When at last I could look over it and beyondlo! the eastern sea with Edge Island rising out of it and the ice-
pack stretching away to a remote and clear horizon. I yelled down
to my friends in camp, then climbed higher and higher and saw to
even greater distances. Aghard Bay just beyond the glacier was
sparkling in sunlight and dotted over with speckles and streaks of
ice. The water was blue; blue, too, were the hills ofEdge Island, and
presently purple; the remotest of them ablaze with yellow light.
Up and up I went, leaning against a gale till all the nearer hills
were disclosed, domes of snow from which the big glacier
V.M. 16 221
descended. The limb of a rainbow was standing upon the ice.
It was a view not merely worth seeing, but well worth having
come to see.
As a specimen of prose it is typical of Conway, the master, it
seems, of almost everything to which he turned his hand. That
he did turn his hand to innumerable subjects is shown by the
record after his return from Spitzbergen, for he had become, it
was soon shown, an expert on half a dozen aspects of the island
and its history.
The following summer he was off again, this time to South
America, on a long, rambling journey, rather more expensive
tban usual, one must imagine, during which he made the first
ascent of Illimani and an ascent of Aconcagua.
The account of what happened on Aconcagua shows, better
than most incidents, the type of man that Conway was. Fitz-
gerald, the young man of whom Conway had had great hopes,
hadhimselfbeen on the mountain the previous year while Conwaywas in Spitzbergen using, incidentally, Matthias Zurbruggen,
Conway's former guide and was generally believed to have
reached the top. When, therefore, Conway reached the final
ridge after infinite trouble, labour, and not a little danger, he
halted,
Fitzgerald's book had not been published at the time ofmy ascent
[he explained later], I thought, and I believe correctly, that it would
be harmful for the prestige of that book, just at the point of issue,
if I were known to have accomplished in a week that was supposed
to have taken Fitzgerald's party several months.
It was only later that Conway learned that Fitzgerald, who
apparently had not taken his training seriously enough, had
broken down on the upper slopes of the mountain and had
allowed bis first ascent to be made by his guide.
From Aconcagua, Conway returned to Valparaiso, then
travelled south to Tierra del Fuego, wandering almost discon-
tentedly; maybe "in search of the Divine" as he called his last
book.
He returned to Britain early in 1899 and two years later took
222
his official farewell to mountaineering by ascending the Breithornwith his daughter. It was her first climb, as it had been his sometwenty-nine years earlier. There was a certain formalised, almostartificial ending to his association with active
mountaineering.He was just forty-seven.
Conway was to fill illustrious positions in the Royal Geographi-cal Society; he was to become President of the Alpine Club andof the Ligue pour la Conservation de la Suisse pittoresque which
fought the Matterhorn railway scheme. He was to become an
important figure, a link with, the mountaineering past, bornbefore the formation of the Alpine Club. He outlived Coolidge,and Freshfield, and when his death came in 1937 he was the last
survivor of the heroic age. Yet after the age of forty-seven his
only climbs were those on a few holiday peaks.The explanation is more simple than one might at first imagine.
For Conway, the mountains had performed their function; theyhad served the purpose for which he believed them to exist.
Conway had gone to the mountains for the same reason that
most other Victorian climbers had, to a lesser or greater degree,
gone to them. He had gone to discover some indication that
man was something more than the six-foot body that contained
him, to discover whether or not he formed an essential part ofan understandable universe. For Conway, seeking more care-
fully, probing more deeply, than some of the others, the
experiences of the mountains had proved that there were, after
all, gods in spite of the scientists. There was still some doubt
as to who they were, and Conway sought new methods of
investigation.
Each book of life that in turn we open we must one day close
[he explained]. All save the last, which we shall be called from half-
read. For all of us there are many kinds ofjoy as yet unexperienced,
many activities untried, many fields ofknowledge unexplored. Wemust not spend too large a fraction of life over one or the next
will escape us. It is life, after all, that is the greatest field of
exploration.
Here, for Conway as for so many of his companions, was the
V.M. 16* 223
real glory; that, half conquerors, half pilgrims, they were able to
stride into the darkness with a confidence found in the Alps,
hoping that they yet might find some all-embracing belief that
had eluded both them and the age through which they had
thundered.
224
INDEXThe numerals in heavy type denote
Abraham brothers, 204; 36Aconcagua, 222
Adams-ReiUy, 26, 48, 130Agassiz, Louis, 44, 45
Aghard Bay, 221
Agnostic's Apology, An, 116, 120
Aiguille d'Argentiere, 130
Aiguilles d'Arves, 27, 38, 184Col des, 129
Aiguille de Biormassay, 183
Aiguille de Trelatete, 130
Aiguille du Moine, 47Aiguille Verte, 58, 130, 157
Aiguilles de la Sausse, Col des, 129Ailefroide, 163
Ainslie, Charles, 73
Albert, Coolidge's manservant, 168; 28Albert, Prince Consort, 53Aletsch Glacier, 21, 108
Aletschhorn, 61
Alfred, Prince, 61
All the Year Round, 134-137, 203AUalin Pass, 69Aimer, Christian, 24, 72, 129, 141, 148-
151, 157, 158, 162, 163, 164, 167"Christian, Young", 24, 151, 163, 164,
168; 14"Aimer's Leap", 141-142, 144
Alpenstocks, 39, 105, 115, 194
Alphubel, 6 1
Alpiglen, 162
Alpine Club, 16, 26, 31, 36, 37, 38, 42, 48,
50, 67, 70, 78-90, 98, 99, no, 120, 124,
133, 139, 141-142, 146, 164, 171, 191,
194, 207, 212, 217, 223
Committee, 126, 147
Members, 24, 37, 52, 54, 77, 91, 93, io<5,
113, 115, 122, 128, 151-152, 168, 197,
211
Presidents, 46, 55, 76, 95, 96-97, 121,
134; 6
Register, 83
Alpine Dining Club, 83, 120
Alpine Guide, 25, 95, 96, 98, 203
Alpine history, 162-163, 165-166, 167,
168, 171, 208
Alpine huts, 16, 54, 62, 63, 94
Alpine Journal, 23, 38, 40, 66, 75, 95, 98,
112, 113, 115, 121, 151, 164, 166,203,
211, 217, 2l8
Alpine Studies, 171
Alp Lusgen, 20
the figure numbers of the illustrations
Alps in Nature and History, The, 168-171,iS5
Alps in 1864, The, 155Altels, 67, 89, 93, 177Ames, E. L., 114Ancien Passage, Mont Blanc, 67
Archaeology, no-iii
Anderegg, Melchior, 89, 119, 177, 182; 15Andes, 126, 137, 139, 140, 202
Angeville, Henriette d', 174-175
Ankogel, 218
Anzasca, Val, 115
Aosta, 175
Ararat, Mount, 74Archer-Thomson, 195
Argentiere, Aiguille d', 130Armenia, 73
Arnold, Matthew, 42, 83
Arolla, 47Arthur, Prince (Duke of Connaught), 31Artists, 23, 64-65, 122
Arves, Aiguilles d*, 27, 38, 184Col des, 129
Ascent of Mont Blanc, 24, 30, 53, 188
Atkinson, Henry, 156, 158
Atkinson, Thomas, 24, 83-84
Auldjo, John, 54
Austria, 58, 218
"Avalanche, The," 39
Avalanches, 26, 105, 124, 173
Baedeker, Herr, 148, 162
Baillie-Grohman, 154Ball, Cima di, 121
Ball, John, 23, 25, 46, 81, 91, 95~98, 168,
193, 203, 212; 6
Balmat, Auguste, 42, 46, 47, 48, 68, 69-70,
71, 72, 106
Michael, 156
Balmoral, 188; 32Baltoro Glacier, 216
Barford, J. E. Q., 203
Barnard, George, 64-65, 156, 206
Mrs., 175
Baumgartner, C. A. O., 193
Bavaria, 119
Beddgelert, 188
Bel Alp, 21, 109, 181; II
Bello, son of Tschingel, 163
Bennen, Johann Joseph, 107-108, 127
Ben Nevis, 194
Bentinck, Lady, 176
225
Brarde, La, 43, 129, 184Bernese Oberknd, 17, 21, 39, 44* 58, 64,
71, 114, 115, 126, 155, 164, 175, 183
Bernina Alps, 58
Bethesda, 194
Beverlcy, William, 53
Biafo Valley, 216
Bietschhorn, <5l, 164
Bionnassay, Aiguille de, 183
Birkbeck, John, 74, inBisson, 115
Blanc, Mont, 16, 19, 44, 54, 55, 5<5, 57,
58-59, 64, 67, 69, 73, 75-76, 87, 89,
106, 114, 115, 119, 151, 155, 156, 158,
163, 164, 174, 175, 181, 184, 194, 195,
218; 31ascent from St. Gervais, 120
ascent by A. Smith, 37, 49-50, 5*-53, 107climbed by women, 174-175, 181
first ascent, 195 first guideless ascent, 74,
75, H5map, 26, 48
tragedy of Dr. Hand's party, 38, 49
Blond, Mrs. Aubrey le, see Le Blond,Mrs. A.
Blumlisalphom, 89, 162
Blunt, Wilfrid Scawen, 83
Bodleian Library, 172
Bohren, Peter, 72
Bonney, Thomas George, 20, 23, 27, 42,
43, 48, 91, 9^-94, 95, 127, 152, 155Bosses du Dromadaire, 151
Bossons, Glacier des, 54"Botherhead" (Rev. Wethered), 25-26
Bourcet, 27, 93
Bourrit, Marc-Theodore, 156
Bowring, Frederick, 191Breche de la Meije, 129Breche de Roland, 43
Breithorn, 208, 223
Bremble, John de, 31Brenva Ridge, 19, 163, 194
Bieuil, 109, 125, 127, 130, 164
Brevoort, Meta, 16, 27, 146-149, 151, 152,
I55-I58, i<5i, 162-165, 174, 177, 181-
183524Brewster, Sir David, 41
Brianfon, 93British Association, 44, 215
Brockedon, William, 19
Brown, Yeats, 19
Browne, G. F., Bishop of Bristol, 133, 134
Browning, Oscar, 65, 134Bruce, Lt. (later General), 215
Brunner, Fratilein, 162
Buet, 23
Burton, Sir Richard, 83
Butler, A.J., 167
Byron, 116
Cader Idris, 90; 43Cairngorm Club, 40Cairngorms, 188
Cambridge University, 61, 79, 133
Campbell, Miss, 19
Mrs., 19Canadian Pacific Railway, 139Canadian Rockies, 84, 140; see also Rocky
Mountains
Capel Curig, 90, 92, *94
Carrel, Felicite", 182
Jean-Antoine, 125, 127, 128, 130, 139
Jean-Jacques, 127, 128
Carrington, Charles, 6 1
Castelnau, Boileau de, 62, 183
Caucasus, 84, 216
Cawood, A. H., 75
Cenis, Mont, 127, 137Chalet Montana, 144, 167, 172
Chamberlain, Joseph, 87
Chamonix, 37, 41, 46, 47, 49, 5O, 51.
52, 54, 55, 5<5, 58, 69, 70, 71, 7<5,
114, 126, 130, 140, 161, 174, 175,
i8i;9Chamonix Polka, 54
Charier, Jean, 181; 30Chimborazo, 139
"Chimney", Matterhorn, 127, 128
Chorley, Lord, 202
Chronicles of St. Bernard, 35-36Cima di Ball, 121
Cima di Jazzi, 148
Cirque de Gavarnie, 43
Clergy, 18, 21-22, 23, 24, 73, 92, 110-121,
165
Cliffe, John Henry, 188
Climbers' Club, 90, 108, 194
Climbing in Britain, 203-204
Climbing in the British Isles, 203
Climbing in the English Lake District, 204Cnicht, 188
Cobbler Club, 186
Col de la FauciUe, 95Col de la Pilatte, 129Col deMiagc, inCol de Voza, 71Col des Aiguilles d'Arves, 129Col des Aiguilles de la Sausse, 129Col des Hirondelles, 121
Col di Tenda, 218
Col du Gant, 19, 38, 106, 119, 148Col du Lautaret, 137Col du Says, 43Col du Sellar, 43
Cole, Mrs., 115, 175, 176
Coleman, E. T., 206
Colgrove, 75
Collie, Norman, 194
Connaught, Duke of, 31
226
Conway, William Martin, 40, 121, 134,
140, 147, 154, 155, 167,205, 206-224;
45Conway and Coolidge's Climbers' Guides,
213-214
Coolidge, W. A. B., 24, 25, 26, 27, 43, 48,
64, 94, 95, 98, 112, 113, 138, 139,
141-144, 145-173, 174, 181, 182, 185,
197, 208, 211, 212, 213-214, 217, 223;
25,28Letter to his mother, 23
Corvatsch Pass, 183
Courmayeur, 35, 163
Couttet, David, 46, 47Couttet, Joseph Marie, 39
Couttet, Sylvain-, 181
Cowell, John, 134Cretins, 28, 93
Crimea, 73
Crowley, Aleister, 215
Croz, Michael, 74, 129, 130-132, 134,
141Gust's Gully, 194Cwm Glas, 188
Cyprus, 214
D'Angeville, Henriette; see Angeville,Henriette d
j
Darwinian thesis, 36, 92, 119, 196
Daudet, Alphonse, 102
Dauphine* Alps, 20, 27, 43, 44, 47, 58, 61,
62, 92, 93, 94, 123, 129, 130, 145, 148,
152, 163, 164, 182, 183, 184
maps, 93
Davidson, Sir W. Edward, 166-167, 175-
176, 185; 19Davies, Llewellyn, 61, 113De Bremble, John, 31De Castelnau, Boileau; see Castlenau, B. de
Delia Disgrazia, Monte, 120
Dent, Clifton, 167Dent d'H&ens, 128
Dent du Midi, 89Dent Blanche, 58, 163
Deep Ghyll, 197De Saussure; see Saussure, de
Diablerets, 162-163
Dickens, Charles, 50, 137
Dictionary of National Biography, 25Doe Crag, 198
Dogs, 24, 151, I55-I5<5, 157-1^3, 164, 165
Dolent, Mont, 58, 130
Dolomites, 43, 58, 77, 95, 164, 175
Dom, 61, 163
Douglas, Lord Francis, 74, 109, 125, 130-
132
Dragons, 27Dress Circle, Napes Needle, 202
Dromadaire, Bosses du, 151
Eagle's Nest, The, 48, 68; 8
Ecuador, 139
Eckenstein, Oscar, 207, 215Ecrins, 43, 129, 141, 163
Edge Island, 221
Edinburgh Philosophical Journal, 41
Edinburgh University, 40-41Edward VII, formerly Prince ofWales, 30,
53, 54, 139
Edwardes, Ernest, 115
Egypt, 214
Egyptian Hall, Mont Blanc Exhibition, 53,
54,55
Eiger, 58, 61, too, 105, 137, 151, 162, 173Elan Dam, 178
Ellerton, John, 114Elliott, Julius, 113, 193
Encyclopaedia Britannica, 167
Engadine, 183, 208
Ennerdale Face, Great Gable, 201
Evans, Dr. Joan, iio-mEverest, Mount, 215
Evolena, 47
Fairbanks, Arthur, 164, 181
Faraday, Michael, 25, 64
Mrs., 175
Farrar, Captain, 75, 132, 134, 142, 146
Faucille, Col de la, 95
Favret, Francois, 54Fell and Rock Climbing Club, 202
Journal of the, 198
Fell-walkers, 188-193, 196Financial aspect of mountaineering, 50, 52,
62, 63, 64, 66, 69, 74, 76
Finsteraarhorn, 29, 57, 58, 67, 71, 79, 106,
114, 151
Fitzgerald, Edward, 217-218, 222
Floyd, Charles G., 51
Forbes, James David, 17, 20, 24, 25, 26,
30, 3<5-37, 40-48, 49, 5<>, 69, 70, 71,
76, 77, 93, 99, 100-102, 106, 107
Fortunatus, 16
Franco-Prussian War, 157, 163
Franklin, 123
Freshfield, Douglas, 31, 54, 84, 154, 166,
167, 214, 216, 223
Mrs., 175
Gaiter Club, 186
"Game of Mont Blanc", 54
Gardiner, Frederick, 64, 75, 164, 182;
13Garrick Club, 50
Gavarnie, Cirque de, 43
G6ant, Cachat le; see Le Ge*ant, C.
G&nt, Col du, 19, 38, 106, 119, 148
Gemmi Pass, 25General Strike, 172
227
Geological Society, 35
Geologists, 21, 22, 23, 43, 92
George, Hereford Brooke, 23, 88, 1 12,
113, 115-119, 151, 157. 158; 12Ghurka Pass, 218
Girdlestone, Rev., 74, 113, 124
Glaciers, 19, 20, 44, 45-47, 55, 58, 68, 95,
105, 107, 126, 137, 158, 214, 216, 221
controversy, 20, 24, 45-47, *6Glacier de Bossons, 54
Gladstone, William, 187
Glyders, 188
Goitrous peasants, 27Golden Age of mountaineering, 17, 26, 27,
31, 57, 61, 63* 68, 91, 123
Grahame, William, 16
Graian Alps, 58, 214Grand Combin, 58
Grand Cornier, 130Grand Paradis, 61
Grand tour, 41, 101
Grand Tournalin, 128
Grande Casse, 61
Grands Mulcts, 52, 115; 31Great Doup, 193
Great End, 194Great Gable, 191, 197, 198, 201
Ennerdale Face, 201
Great St. Bernard Pass, 3 1
Grave, La, 129
Greenland, 126, 137, 139
Grenoble, 93
Gressoney, 178
Grimsel, 105, 114Grimsel Hospice, 44, 46
Grindelwald, 17, 58, 72, 105, 144, 147, 148,
158, 161, 167, 168, 171; 16, 28as base for Wetterhorn, 17, 59, 69
guides, 22Grindelwald Glacier, 158; 12
Lower, 105
Grohman, Baillie-, 154Gross Glockner, 218
Gross-Nesthorn, 115
Grove, Cranford, 194
Guggi, 105Guide books, 19, 25, 42, 47, 74, 76, 95, 96,
98, 139, 147, 167, 168, 201-202, 203-204, 211, 212-214
Guide-chef, 28
Guide to the Central Alps, 98Guide to the Eastern Alps, 98Guide to the Western Alps, 98, 168
Guideless mountaineering, 56, 59, 64, 74-75,
87, H3Guides, 16, 20, 21, 28, 39, 42, 43, 46, 47,
48, 51, 54, 57, 62, 63, 64, 66, 67, 68,
69, 70-71, 72, 74, 76, 88-89, 95, 107-108, 125, 127-128, 129, 149, 151, 158,
163, 164, 174, 175, 181, 182, 183, 204,
215, 217, 222
Gurnard's Head, 194
Hadow, Douglas, 74, 125, 130-132, 134
Hamel, Dr., 39, 49, 67
Hardman, Ellis, 82
Hardy, J. F., 79, 113, 119
Harrison, Frederic, 29-30, 196
Haskett-Smith, W. P., 195, 196, 197-201,
202-204; 41Hastings, Geoffrey, 195
Hawkins, Francis Vaughan, 114, 127
Hawkshaw, John Clarke, 93, 94
Heidelberg, 102
H&rens, Dent d', 128
High Alps without Guides, The, 74
Highland Mountain Club, 186
Hill-wanderers, 188
Himalayas, 20, 167, 181, 207, 216, 217, 218
HinchlifF, Thomas, 66, 67-68, 76, 77, 81,
H9, 193
Hindhead, 109Hindu Kush, 20
Hirondelles, Col des, 121
Hispar Glacier, 216
Hooker, Dr., 105
Hornby, 162
Hornli, 183
Hort, Fentonjohn Anthony, 79, 80-81, 82,
99, 113, 114, 119, 124, 126
H6tel des Londres, Chamonix, 50, 52"Hotel des Neuchatelois", 44, 46Hours ofExercise in the Alps, 108
Hudson, Charles, 61, 64, 73-76, 108, in,113, 114, 126, 130-132; 5
Huts, Alpine, 16, 54, 62, 63, 94
Huxley, Prof., 105, 194
Ice axes, 96, 155
niirnani, 222
Illustrated London News, 49
Imboden, Roman, 184
India, 207Inn conditions in Switzerland, 26-27, 66,
93-94Innsbruck, 41
Interlaken, 69, 72, 105, 133
Inverclyde, Lord, 186
Italian Alpine Club, 133
Jackson, James, 192-193; 37Mrs., 33
Japanese Alps, 84
Jardin, 69, 126
Jazzi, Cima di, 148
Jerrold, Douglas, 50
Joad, G., 114-115
John Rylands Library, Manchester, 171
228
Jones, O. G., 195, 201-202, 204; 38Josias Simler et les Origines de I*Alpinisms
jusqu'ou 1600, 168
Journal of the Fell and Rock Climbing Clubof Great Britain, 198
Jungfrau, 19, 29, 44, 57, 58, 71, 89, 105,114, 115, 158, 162, 164, 218
first British ascent, 44Jungfraujoch, 120
Jura, 39
Karakoram, 20, 214, 215Kaufmarm, Ulrica, 72Keen, Mount, 42Kennedy, Edward Shirley, 16, 64, 73, 74,
75, 79, 80, 97, 113, 114, 115, 119, 157Kippel, 162
Koecher, Miss, 201
La B6rarde, 43, 129, 184Ladies' Alpine Club, 184La Grave, 129Lake District, 76, 187, 191, 193, 195, 197,
198, 201
Langkofel, 43
Languard Pass, 92, 183
Lauener, Ukich, 71, 72Lautaret, Col du, 137Le Blond, Mrs. Aubrey, 176-177, 184-185Le G6ant, Cachat, 41
Leasowes, The, 79-80, 113Leaves from A Journal of Our Life in the
Highlands, 188
Leopold I, of the Belgians, 53
Lepontine Alps, 58
Leukerbad, 25
Lewis-Lloyd, Emmeline, 178-181; 29Lightfoot, Canon, 113, 114Llanberis Pass, 90
Lloyd, Emmeline Lewis-, 178-181; 29Llyn Gwynant, 90
Lochgoilhead, 186
Lochnagar, 188; 32London University, 69, 94Londres, H6tel de, Chamonix, 50, 52
Longman, William, 76-77, 81-82, 97,
123, 153, 193
Longmans, publishers, 76, 156
Lunn, Sir Arnold, 83
Lusgen Alp, 109
Lusgen, Villa, 109
MacCormick, A. D., 207, 215Macdonald, Reginald, 127, 128, 194
Macugnaga, 215Mallet, Mont, 58, 121
Malvem Beacon, 208
"Man ofMont Blanc" (A. Smith), 17, 23,
30, 37, 49-56, 107, 188
Man in the Moon, The, 49Maps, 26, 27, 48, 93
Marburg, 102
Marjelensee, 108
Marmolata, 43Mathews, Benjamin St. John Attwood, 79
Charles Edward, 16, 43, 79, 87-88, 89-90, 91, 92, 98, 101, 140, 161, 186
William, 78-80, 89, 93William, Jun., 79
Matterhom, 17, 21, 25, 26, 38, 45, 47, 58,6l 62, 73, 89, 107, 108-109, H3, H4,123-124, 125-126, 127, 128, 129,130-137, 139, 142, 143, 145, 146, 154.161, 182, 193, 195, 197, 223
climbed from Breuil, 109, 125climbed from Zermatt, 17, 26first lady's ascent, 164, 182
guideless ascent, 74-75tragedy and first ascent, 25, 48, 62, 74,
80, 102, 108-109, 112, 113, 123-124,130, 137, 138, 140, 153, 187
Meije, 61, 62, 75, 145, 154, 163, 182-184guideless ascent, 75
Meije, Breche de la, 129Mer de Glace, 41, 46, 71, 92, 126, 175;
9. 17, 18
Meyer, Maud, 84-85; 34Meyers, 29, 58
Miage, Col de, inMidi, Dent du 89Milestone Buttress, Tryfaen, 129Modern Painters, 24, 30-31, 37, 47, 119Moel Hebog, 188
Moine, Aiguille du, 47Morning Pass, 130
Monch, 58, 89
Monchjoch, 115Mont Blanc; see Bknc, Mont"Mont Blanc, Game of", 54"Mont Blanc Quadrille", 54"Mont Blanc Sideshow", 24, 30, 53, 188Mont Cenis; see Cenis, MontMont Dolent; see Dolent, MontMont Mallet; see Mallet, MontMont Pelvoux; see Pelvoux, MontMontanvert, 25, 41, 46, 106, 126Monte Delia Disgrazia; see Delia Dis-
grazia, MonteMonte Moro Pass, 69Monte Rosa; see Rosa, MonteMonte Viso; see Viso, MonteMoore, A. W., 43, 83, 120, 129, 130, 154,
155, 194Moro Pass, Monte, 69Morshead, Frederick, 56, 64Mount Ararat, 74Mount Everest, 215Mount Keen, 42
229
Mountaineering, 194
Mountaineering clothes, 175, 176-177
equipment, 62, 63, 96, 99, 115, 129, 152
Mountaineering in Britain, 61, 87, 89,
186-205
Mountaineering in 1861, 77
Mountaineering technique, 20, 30, 57, 62,
63, 132Mnmm, A. L., 83, 87
Mummery, 214-215
Murray, John, 19, 167, 168
Mymbyr Lakes, 92
Nagar, 215
Nantgwyllt, 178, 181
Napes Needle, 198-201, 202
Napes Ridges, 198
Napoleon, 126
National Education League, 87
Needle, Napes, 198-201, 202
"Neuchatelois, Hotel des", 44, 46
North Wales, 187, 188, 193, 194; 43 44see also Wales
Norway, 47, 84-87, 184, 202
Old Weisthor, 108
Outline Sketches in the High Alps of Dau-
phine1
, 155"Overland Mail, The", 49, 5
Owen, Harry, 191
Oxford Alpine Club, 115
Oxford University, 41, 147, 163
Packe, Charles, 76, 84, I93> 198
Paillon, Mary, 184Pall Mall Gazette, 201
Paradis, Maria, 174Parker brothers, 75, 127Parson's Nose, 188
"Patriarch of the Pillarites" (J. Jackson),
192-193
Pavey Ark Gully, 197
Peaks, Passes and Glaciers, 66, 75, 77, 95,
97-98, 99, 123
Peasants ofChamouni, The, 49
Peel, Sir Robert, 52-53
Pelmo, 95Pelvoux, Mont, 92, 94, 123, 127, 141, 163
Pen-y-Gwryd, 90, 191; 43Pennine Alps, 19, 58, 61, 128, 164
Perthes, Boucher de, noPerthshire Mountain Club, 186
Perthshire Society of Natural History, 186
Philips, Francis, 5 1
Philpott, The Rev. T. H., 162
Photography, 114-115
Pigeon, Ellen, 175, 185
Pilatte, Col de la, 129
Pilkington, Charles and Lawrence, 75,
167, 194; 13Pillar Rock, 113, 192-193, 196, 197, 201
Pioneer in the High Alps, A, 171
Pioneer Peak, 216
Piz Corvatsch, 183
Piz Ghurka, 218
Piz Languard, 92, 183
Plan des ties, 163
Playground ofEurope, The, 121
Ponsonby, Sir Henry, 187
Porters, 44, 51, 62, 63, 130Prior's Guide, 201-202
Punch, 49
Pyrenees, 43, 76, 84, 181, 193, W, 198, 202
Racefor Life, A, 100
Railways in Switzerland, 26, 223
Ramsay, 20, 75, 91, 106
Regrets of a Mountaineer, 64Rhone Glacier, 105Rhone Valley, 58, 106, 109
Richardson, Kathleen, 183-184
Rirlelberg, 47Riffelhorn, 95, 176
Rigi, 102
Rimpfischhorn, 6r
Robinson, John Wilson, 196-197; 39Roche Melon, 100
Rocky Mountains, 139, 202; see also
Canadian Rockies
Rodier, Joseph, 43
Roland, Breche de, 43Romanche Valley, 27, 58
"Rope Wall", 129
Rosa, Monte, 58, 61, 67, 74, 75, 89, 93,
114, 120, 128, 211, 218
guideless ascent, 106
Rousseau, Jean-Jacques, 116
Route Napol6on, 129
Royal Geographical Society, 215, 223
Royal Institution, 20, 36
Royal Society, 41, 106, 215Rucksack Club, 90Ruskin, John, 17, 20, 24, 30-40, 42, 45,
47, 48, 49, 5<5, 64, 65, 67, 73, 105, 114,
134, 206; 2Ruwenzori Mountains, 84
Sackville-West, William Edward, 51St. Bernard dogs, 30, 54St. Bernard Pass, Great, 31St. Gervais, 64, 114, 120
St. Jean de Maurienne, 38St. Michael in the Arc Valley, 129St. Nicholas Valley, 95
Sala, 50, 51
Sallanches, 71
230
Saturday Review, 194Sausse, Col des Aiguilles de la, 129Saussure, de, 19, 31, 36, 40, 41, 52, 156
Says, Col du, 43Scawfell Pinnacle, 197, 198
Scheidcgg, 162
Little, 105
Scheuchzer, 27Schreckhorn, 58, 71, 120, 137, 162, 193
Schwareubach, 177
Schwartzthor, 95
Schynigc Platte, 69Scientific approach to mountaineering, 17,
21, 23, 33, 36, 44, 91, 94, 95, 99, 100, 107
Scientists, 17, 18-23, 36, 40-48, 91-109, inScotland, 194, 195, 202
Scottish Mountaineering Club, 186
Scrambles amongst the Alps, 108, 112, 121,
124, 125, 126, 128, 131, 133, 134,
137-138, 139, 141, 143, 155
Scriven, George, 208, 211
Seatree, George, 39Sebastopol, 73
Sellar, Col du, 43
Se"miond, 27
Sesiajoch, 175
Shipton, Eric, 36
Siddons, Mrs., 41
Silberhorn, 162
Silver Age of mountaineering, 61
Simler, Josias, i<58
Simond, Auguste, 72
Simplon, 45Sixt Valley, 48, 68
Skye, 194
Slade, Frederick, 19
Slingsby, Cecil, 84-87, 184, 186, 187, 194,
195; 35Smith, Albert, 17, 23, 30, 37, 49~5 <5 > I07
188; 4Smith, W. P. Haskett-, 195, 196, 197-201,
202-204
Smyth brothers, 73, 74, 75, H3 "4Smythe, Frank, 36, 138
Snowdon, 20, 90, 92, 188, 194, 195, 207Snowdon Horseshoe, 89
"Soaped pole" jibe, 32, 37
Society of Welsh Rabbits, 90, 186-187
Solly, Godfrey Allan, 194, 195Somme Valley, noSouth Africa, 84
Spain, 202
Spirit of Travel, The, 76
Spitzbergen, 218-222
Spooner, 201, 202
Stelvio, 25
Stephen, Leslie, 25, 31, 35, 3$, 38, $4, 88,
99-100, 112, 113, 115, 116-121, 138,
167, 193-194; I5 *6
Stogdon, John, 64, 181-182
Story of Mont Blanc, The, 53
Strahlegg Pass, 148
Straton, Miss, 16, 178-181; 29, 30Studer, Prof., 29, 47
Sty Head, 39Summer Months among tlie Alps, 68, 76, 77
Superstitions, Alpine, 21, 27-28, 58, 62, 93Swiss Alpine Club, 133, 141-142, 172Swiss mountaineers, 29, 58, 6 1
Swiss Travel and Swiss Guide-Books, 167
Switzerland, 167
Sylvain-Couttet, Madame, 181
Syria, 214
Tartarin on the Alps, 102
Taugwalder, Peter (old), 130-131Peter (young), 131
brothers, 74, 130, 134
Tenda, Col di, 218
The"odule Pass, 19, 69, 94, 125, 148
Thomson, Archer-, J. M., 195
Thorington, Monroe, Dr., 161-162
Tlioughts on Being, 73
Thun, 25
Tiarraz, 50Tierra del Fuego, 222
Tilman, H. W., 36Time and Chance, noTimes, The, 102, 133, 134, 137, 167
Torrenthom, 71, 162
Travel facilities in Switzerland, 26-27Travels amongst the Great Andes. . . , 139Travels among the Alps of Savoy, 42, 47, 76
Trelate'te, Aiguille de, 130
Trollope, Anthony, 82
Trou de Toro, 43
Tryfaen, 129
Tschingel, 24, 151, I55~I5<5, 157-163, 164,
165; 26, 27Tschingel Pass, 69
Tuckett, Francis Fox, 23, 43, 91, 94, 98-
101, 142, 151-1 52 ^54, 155, 171, 194
Turin, 94
Turkey, 214
Tyndall, John, 20, 24, 36, 40, 42, 45, 48,
77, 9i, 99-ioo, 101-109, 125, 127,
128, 194, 195; 7 IJ
University students, 61, 66
Unteraar Glacier, 44, 45, 105
Unwin, T. Fisher, 213-214
Uri, 114
Val Anzasca, 115
Valgaudemar, 43
Vallouise, 44
Valparaiso, 222
V6non Valley, 43
231
Victor-Emmanuel, 178
Victoria, Queen, 30, 53, 54, 57, 187, 188;
32Viescherjoch, 120
Villa Lusgen, 109Viso, Monte, 43, 94, 218
Voza, Col de, 71
"Wales, 194, 195, 202; see also North "Wales
"Wales, Prince of, afterwards Edward VII,
30, 53, 54, 139
Walker, Francis, 19, 182
Horace, 89, 129, 142, 154, 194
Lucy, 162, 174, 177-178, 181, 182
Walton, Elizah, 206
Wanderings among the High Alps, 61, 68,
76, 77, H9Wastdale Head, 197, 203; 40Weisshorn, 45, 58, 89, 107-108, 124, 163
Weisthor, Old, 108
"Wengern Alp, 25, 115
West, William Edward Sackville-, 51
Westmorland, Kate, 192
brothers, 192Wethered, Rev., 25-26Wetterhorn, 17, 58, 89, 105, 151, 164, 172,
208
ascent by Wills, 48, 55, 61, 68, 69, 71-72,in
Where There's a Will There's a Way, 75,
Whymper, Edward, 17, 20, 24, 25, 27, 38,
43, 61, 62, 73, 80, 88, 92, 108, 111-112,
113, 121, 122-144, 153-154, 163; 20,21
Matterhorn tragedy, 25, 48, 74, 112,
123-124, 130-137tent, 129
Wilberforce, Bishop of Oxford, 128-129Wilde, Oscar, 68
Willink, H. G., 206
Wills, Sir Alfred, 17, 48, 55, 61, 64, 68-73,
76, 77, 88, 106, in, 119; 3, 8
Mrs., 175Women mountaineers, 19, 61, 84-85, 162,
174-185
Year-book of the Swiss Alpine Club, 141Yorkshire Ramblers' Club, 90, 187
Young, Geoffrey Winthrop, 36, 75, 90,
197
Zermatt, 47, 58, 69, 74, 94, 95, 109, "4.123, 126, 129, 133, 134, 138, 140, 144,
146, 161, 162, 164, 176, 184, 193, 211;10
Zermatt Pocket Book, 211-212Zinal Rothhorn, 176
Zug, 102
Zurbruggen, Matthias, 215, 217, 222
Zurich, 102, 119
c z
8815